target, breakpoints: improve error handling
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1810 following example.
1811 @end itemize
1812
1813 @example
1814 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1816 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1819 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1820 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1821 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1822 > resume
1823 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1824 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1825 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1826 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1827 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1828 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1829 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1830 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1831 @end example
1832
1833
1834 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1835
1836 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1837 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1838 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1839
1840 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1841 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1842 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1843 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1844 both signals.
1845
1846 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1847 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1848 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1849 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1850 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1851 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1852 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1853 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1854 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1855 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1856 not available.)
1857
1858 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1859 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1860 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1861 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1862 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1863 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1864 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1865 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1866
1867 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1868 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1869 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1870 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1871 slower clock than they will use later.
1872 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1873 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1874 than they will use later.
1875 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1876
1877 @quotation Important
1878 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1879 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1880 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1881 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1882 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1883 @end quotation
1884
1885 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1886 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1887 @cindex init_targets procedure
1888
1889 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1890 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1891 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1892 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1893 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1894 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1895 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1896 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1897 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1898
1899 @example
1900 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1901
1902 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1903 # basic initialization procedure ...
1904 @}
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1909 @}
1910
1911 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1912
1913 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1914
1915 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1916 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1917 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1918 @}
1919 @end example
1920
1921 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1922 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1923
1924 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1925
1926 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1928
1929 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1930 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1931 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1932
1933 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1934 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1935 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1936 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1937 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1938 events already assigned.
1939
1940 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1941
1942 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1943 special high speed download features - enable it.
1944
1945 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1946
1947 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1948 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1949 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1950 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1951 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1952 If you are using an external trace port,
1953 configure it in your board config file.
1954 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1955 configure it in your target config file.
1956
1957 @example
1958 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1959 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1960 @end example
1961
1962 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1963
1964 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1965
1966 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1967 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1968 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1969 the TARGET (chip) file.
1970
1971 Examples:
1972 @itemize @bullet
1973 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1974 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1975 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1976 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1977 @end itemize
1978
1979 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1980 @section Translating Configuration Files
1981 @cindex translation
1982 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1983 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1984 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1985 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1986 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1987 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1988
1989 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1990 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1991 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1992 convert other scripts later on.
1993
1994 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1995 replace job:
1996
1997 @example
1998 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1999 #
2000 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2001 #
2002 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2003 #
2004 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2005
2006 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2007 global TARGETNAME
2008
2009 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2010
2011 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2012 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2014 @}
2015 @end example
2016
2017
2018
2019 @node Server Configuration
2020 @chapter Server Configuration
2021 @cindex initialization
2022 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2023 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2024 supported.
2025
2026 @anchor{configurationstage}
2027 @section Configuration Stage
2028 @cindex configuration stage
2029 @cindex config command
2030
2031 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2032 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2033 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2034 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2035 inside startup scripts.
2036
2037 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2038 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2039 which may be issued interactively.
2040 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2041 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2042
2043 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2044 flash banks,
2045 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2046 and other basic setup.
2047 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2048 may access or activate TAPs.
2049 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2050 longer be issued.
2051
2052 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2053 @section Entering the Run Stage
2054
2055 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2056 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2057 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2058 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2059 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2060 You should see no errors at this point.
2061 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2062 commands you used to configure the server.
2063 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2064 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2065 on the scan chain.
2066
2067 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2068 become available.
2069 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2070 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2071 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2072 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2073 entry to the run stage.
2074
2075 @deffn {Config Command} init
2076 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2077 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2078 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2079 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2080 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2081 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2082
2083 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2084 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2085 configuration files and/or command line options.
2086
2087 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2088 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2089 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2090 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2091 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2092 @end deffn
2093
2094 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2095 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2096 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2097
2098 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2099 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2100 scan chain.
2101 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2102 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2103
2104 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2105 they return.
2106 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2107 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2108 @end deffn
2109
2110 @anchor{tcpipports}
2111 @section TCP/IP Ports
2112 @cindex TCP port
2113 @cindex server
2114 @cindex port
2115 @cindex security
2116 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2117 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2118 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2119
2120 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2121 access using one or more of these ports.
2122 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2123 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2124 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2125
2126 @anchor{gdb_port}
2127 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2128 @cindex GDB server
2129 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2130 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2131 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2132 the normal use cases.
2133
2134 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2135 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2136 disables the gdb server.
2137
2138 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2139 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2140
2141 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2142 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2143
2144 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2145 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2146 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2147
2148 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2149 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2150 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2151 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2152 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2153 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2154 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2155 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2156 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2157
2158 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2159 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2160 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2161 @end deffn
2162
2163 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2164 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2165 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2166 output from the Tcl engine.
2167 Intended as a machine interface.
2168 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2169 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2170 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2174 Specify or query the
2175 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2176 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2177 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2178 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2179 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2180 @end deffn
2181
2182 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2183 @section GDB Configuration
2184 @cindex GDB
2185 @cindex GDB configuration
2186 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2187 The ones listed here are static and global.
2188 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2189 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2190
2191 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2192 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2193 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2194 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2195 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2196 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2197 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2198 @end deffn
2199
2200 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2201 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2202 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2203 vFlash packet is received.
2204 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2209 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2210 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2211 for flash programming to work.
2212 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2213 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2214 @end deffn
2215
2216 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2217 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2218 by GDB memory read packets.
2219 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2220 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2221 @end deffn
2222
2223 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2224 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2225 packets report errors or not.
2226 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2227 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2232 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2233 @end deffn
2234
2235 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2236 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2237
2238 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2239 @end deffn
2240
2241 @anchor{eventpolling}
2242 @section Event Polling
2243
2244 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2245 where significant events can happen at any time.
2246 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2247 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2248 or to GDB.
2249
2250 Examples of such events include:
2251
2252 @itemize
2253 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2254 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2255 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2256 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2257 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2258 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2259 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2260 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2261 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2262 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2263 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2264 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2265 @end itemize
2266
2267 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2268 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2269 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2270 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2271 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2272
2273 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2274 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2275 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2276 to the various active targets.
2277 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2278 which is normally done in the background.
2279
2280 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2281 Poll the current target for its current state.
2282 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2283 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2284 specific information about the current state is printed.
2285 An optional parameter
2286 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2287
2288 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2289 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2290 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2291 @example
2292 > poll
2293 background polling: on
2294 target state: halted
2295 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2296 current mode: Supervisor
2297 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2298 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2299 >
2300 @end example
2301 @end deffn
2302
2303 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2304 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @cindex config file, interface
2306 @cindex interface config file
2307
2308 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2309 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2310 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2311
2312 @quotation Note
2313 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2314 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2315 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2316 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2317 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2318 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2319 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2320 @end quotation
2321
2322 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2323 through commands in an interface configuration
2324 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2325 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2326
2327 @example
2328 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2329 @end example
2330
2331 These commands tell
2332 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2333 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2334
2335 @example
2336 # jlink interface
2337 interface jlink
2338 @end example
2339
2340 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2341
2342
2343 @section Interface Configuration
2344
2345 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2346 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2347 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2348
2349 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2350 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2351 target.
2352 @end deffn
2353
2354 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2355 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2356 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2357 @end deffn
2358 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2359 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2360 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2361 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2362 the hardware can support.
2363 @end deffn
2364
2365
2366
2367 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2368 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2369 @end deffn
2370
2371 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2372 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2373 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2374 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2375 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2376 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2377
2378 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2379 @end deffn
2380
2381 @section Interface Drivers
2382
2383 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2384 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2385 available at run time.
2386
2387 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2388 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2389 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2390 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2391
2392 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2393 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2394 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2395 @end deffn
2396
2397 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2398 Displays status of RTCK option.
2399 Optionally sets that option first.
2400 @end deffn
2401 @end deffn
2402
2403 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2404 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2405 This has one driver-specific command:
2406
2407 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2408 Logs some status
2409 @end deffn
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2413 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2414 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2415 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2416 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2417 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2418 @end deffn
2419
2420 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2421 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2422
2423 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2424 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2425 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2426 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2427 @example
2428 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2429 @end example
2430 @end deffn
2431
2432 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2433 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2434 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2435 @end deffn
2436
2437 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2438 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2439 @end deffn
2440 @end deffn
2441
2442 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2443 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2444 @end deffn
2445
2446 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2447 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2448 @end deffn
2449
2450 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2451 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2452 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2453
2454 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2455 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2456
2457 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2458 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2459
2460 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2461 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2462 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2463 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2464 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2465 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2466
2467 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2468 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2469 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2470 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2471 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2472
2473 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2474 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2475 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2476 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2477
2478 @itemize @minus
2479 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2480 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2481 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2482 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2483 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2484 switching data and direction as necessary
2485 @end itemize
2486
2487 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2488 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2489
2490 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2491 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2492 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2493 @example
2494 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2495 @end example
2496 @end deffn
2497
2498 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2499 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2500 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2501 during device selection.
2502 @end deffn
2503
2504 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2505 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2506 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2507 is connected to the host.
2508 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2509 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2510 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2511 @end deffn
2512
2513 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2514 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2515 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2516 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2517 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2518 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2519
2520 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2521 @end deffn
2522
2523 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2524 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2525 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2529 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2530 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2531 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2532 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2533 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2534 and initially asserted reset signals.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2538 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2539 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2540 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2541 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2542 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2543 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2544 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2545 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2546 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2547 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2548
2549 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2550 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2551 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2552 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2553 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2554 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2555
2556 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2557 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2558 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2559 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2560 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2561 are always driven by the FTDI.
2562
2563 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2564 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2565 @var{name}.
2566 @end deffn
2567
2568 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2569 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2570 @itemize @minus
2571 @item @option{0}, drive low
2572 @item @option{1}, drive high
2573 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2574 @end itemize
2575 @end deffn
2576
2577 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2578 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2579 @end deffn
2580
2581 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2582 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2583
2584 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2585 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2586 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2587 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2588 @itemize @minus
2589 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2590 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2591 @end itemize
2592 @end deffn
2593
2594 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2595 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2596
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2600 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2601 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2602 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2603
2604 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2605 @itemize @minus
2606 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2607 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2608 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2609 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2610 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2611 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2612 @end itemize
2613
2614 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2615 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2616 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2617 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2618 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2619 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2620 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2621 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2622
2623 FT232R
2624 @itemize @minus
2625 @item bit 7 - RI
2626 @item bit 6 - DCD
2627 @item bit 5 - DSR
2628 @item bit 4 - DTR
2629 @item bit 3 - CTS
2630 @item bit 2 - RTS
2631 @item bit 1 - RXD
2632 @item bit 0 - TXD
2633 @end itemize
2634
2635 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2636 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2637
2638 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2639 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2640 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2641 @end deffn
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2644 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2645 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2646 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2647 @end deffn
2648
2649 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2650 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2651 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2655 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2656 @end deffn
2657
2658 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2659 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2660 @end deffn
2661
2662 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2663 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2664 @end deffn
2665
2666 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2667 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2668 @end deffn
2669
2670 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2671 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2672 @end deffn
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2675 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2676 @end deffn
2677
2678 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2679 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2680 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2681 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2682 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2683 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2684 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2685 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2686 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2687 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2693 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2694 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2695 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2696
2697 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2698 processors which are being simulated.
2699
2700 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2701 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2702 sockets instead of TCP.
2703 @end deffn
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2706 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2707 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2711 something like:
2712
2713 @example
2714 interface remote_bitbang
2715 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2716 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2717 @end example
2718
2719 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2720 named mysocket:
2721
2722 @example
2723 interface remote_bitbang
2724 remote_bitbang_port 0
2725 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2726 @end example
2727 @end deffn
2728
2729 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2730 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2731 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2732 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2733
2734 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2735 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2736 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2737 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2738 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2742 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2743 default values are used.
2744 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2745 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2746 @example
2747 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2748 @end example
2749 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2750 @example
2751 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2752 @end example
2753 @end deffn
2754
2755 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2756 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2757 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2758 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2759 target board.
2760
2761 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2762 @example
2763 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2764 reset_config srst_only
2765 @end example
2766 @end deffn
2767
2768 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2769 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2770 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2771 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2772 @end deffn
2773
2774 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2775 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2776 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @end deffn
2780
2781 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2782 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2783 This has one driver-specific command:
2784
2785 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2786 Display either the address of the I/O port
2787 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2788 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2789 This is a write-once setting.
2790 @end deffn
2791 @end deffn
2792
2793 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2794 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2795 transports.
2796
2797 @quotation Compatibility Note
2798 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2799 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2800 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2801 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2802 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2803 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2804 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2805 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2806 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2807 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2808 @end quotation
2809
2810 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2811 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2812 states.
2813 @end deffn
2814 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2815 Display free device internal memory.
2816 @end deffn
2817 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2818 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2819 command version.
2820 @end deffn
2821 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2822 Display the device configuration.
2823 @end deffn
2824 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2825 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2826 power state.
2827 @end deffn
2828 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2829 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2830 @end deffn
2831 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2832 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2833 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2834 IP configuration.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2837 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2838 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2839 @end deffn
2840 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2841 Reset the current configuration.
2842 @end deffn
2843 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2844 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2845 @end deffn
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2847 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2848 pairs.
2849
2850 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2851 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2852 @example
2853 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2854 @end example
2855 @end deffn
2856 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2857 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2858 pairs.
2859
2860 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2861 @example
2862 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2863 77a90000
2864 @end example
2865 @end deffn
2866 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2867 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2868 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2869 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2870 instead.
2871
2872 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2873 @end deffn
2874 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2875 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2876 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2877
2878 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2879 @end deffn
2880 @end deffn
2881
2882 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2883 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2884 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2885 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2886 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2887 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2888 configuration script.
2889
2890 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2891 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2892 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2893 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2894 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2895
2896 Known limitations:
2897 @itemize @bullet
2898 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2899 and 2.7 MHz.
2900 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2901 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2902 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2903 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2904 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2905 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2906 communications with the target.
2907 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2908 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2909 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2910 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2911 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2912 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2913 @end itemize
2914
2915 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2916 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2917 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2918 @end deffn
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2921 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2922 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2926 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2927 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2928 target as a side-effect.
2929 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2930 @end deffn
2931
2932 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2933 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2934 version, and target voltage.
2935 @end deffn
2936 @end deffn
2937
2938 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2939 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2940 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2941 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2942 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2943
2944 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2945 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2946 This is a write-once setting.
2947 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2948
2949 @itemize @minus
2950 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2951 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2952 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2953 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2954 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2955 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2956 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2957 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2958 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2959 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2960 some versions of
2961 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2962 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2963 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2964 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2965 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2966 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2967 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2968 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2969 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2970 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2971 @end itemize
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2975 Display either the address of the I/O port
2976 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2977 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2978 This is a write-once setting.
2979
2980 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2981 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2982 you may encounter a problem.
2983 @end deffn
2984
2985 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2986 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2987 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2988 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2989 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2990 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2991
2992 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2993 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2994 @quotation Tip
2995 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2996 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2997 @example
2998 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2999 > adapter_khz 500
3000 @end example
3001 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3002 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3003 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3004 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3005 large set of samples.
3006 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3007 @example
3008 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3009 @end example
3010 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3011 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3012
3013 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3014 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3015 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3016 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3017 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3018 @end quotation
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3022 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3023 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3027 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3028
3029 @example
3030 interface parport
3031 parport_port 0x278
3032 parport_cable wiggler
3033 @end example
3034 @end deffn
3035
3036 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3037 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3038 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3039 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3040 @end deffn
3041 @end deffn
3042
3043 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3044 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3045 @end deffn
3046
3047 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3048 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3049 @end deffn
3050
3051 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3052 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3053
3054 @quotation Note
3055 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3056 which are not currently documented here.
3057 @end quotation
3058 @end deffn
3059
3060 @anchor{hla_interface}
3061 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3062 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3063 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3064 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3065
3066 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3067 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3068 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3069 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3070 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3071
3072 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3073 Currently Not Supported.
3074 @end deffn
3075
3076 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3077 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3081 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3085 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3089 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3090 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3091 @end deffn
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3095 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3096 @end deffn
3097
3098 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3099 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3100 @end deffn
3101
3102 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3103 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3104 @end deffn
3105
3106 @quotation Note
3107 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3108 which are not currently documented here.
3109 @end quotation
3110
3111 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3112 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3113 No arguments: print status.
3114 @end deffn
3115
3116 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3117 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3118 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3119
3120 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3121 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3122 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3123 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3124 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3125 configuration on exit.
3126
3127 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3128 pinout.
3129
3130 @end deffn
3131
3132 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3133 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3134 of the one which is most popular.
3135
3136 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3137
3138 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3139 pinout.
3140
3141 @end deffn
3142
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3145 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3146 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3147
3148 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3149 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3150 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3151
3152 @itemize @minus
3153 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3154 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3155 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3156 @end itemize
3157 @end deffn
3158
3159 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3160 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3161 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3162 @end deffn
3163 @end deffn
3164
3165 @section Transport Configuration
3166 @cindex Transport
3167 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3168 and the debug adapter you are using,
3169 several transports may be available to
3170 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3171 @deffn Command {transport list}
3172 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3173 version of OpenOCD.
3174 @end deffn
3175
3176 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3177 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3178
3179 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3180 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3181 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3182 adapter's driver).
3183
3184 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3185 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3186 supported by the debug adapter.
3187
3188 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3189 transport, if any.
3190 @end deffn
3191
3192 @subsection JTAG Transport
3193 @cindex JTAG
3194 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3195 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3196 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3197 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3198 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3199 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3200
3201 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3202 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3203 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3204 hla_jtag}.
3205
3206 @subsection SWD Transport
3207 @cindex SWD
3208 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3209 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3210 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3211 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3212 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3213 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3214 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3215
3216 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3217 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3218 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3219 hla_swd}.
3220
3221 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3222 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3223 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3224 expected to change.
3225 @end deffn
3226 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3227 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3228 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3229 No parameters: displays current settings.
3230 @end deffn
3231
3232 @subsection SPI Transport
3233 @cindex SPI
3234 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3235 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3236 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3237 solution for flash programming.
3238
3239 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3240 @section JTAG Speed
3241 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3242 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3243 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3244 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3245 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3246 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3247 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3248 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3249 power management software that may be active.
3250
3251 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3252 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3253 target event handler.
3254 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3255 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3256 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3257 sets up those clocks).
3258 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3259 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3260 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3261 in the target config file.
3262 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3263 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3264 config file instead.
3265 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3266 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3267 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3268
3269 @example
3270 jtag_rclk 3000
3271 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3272 @end example
3273
3274 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3275 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3276 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3277 may not be the fastest solution.
3278
3279 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3280 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3281 which support adaptive clocking.
3282
3283 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3284 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3285 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3286 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3287 than the speed specified.
3288
3289 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3290 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3291 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3292 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3293
3294 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3295 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3296 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3297 JTAG clocking after setup.
3298 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3299 If the interface device can not
3300 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3301 @end deffn
3302
3303 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3304 @cindex adaptive clocking
3305 @cindex RTCK
3306 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3307 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3308 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3309 @example
3310 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3311 jtag_rclk 3000
3312 @end example
3313 @end defun
3314
3315 @node Reset Configuration
3316 @chapter Reset Configuration
3317 @cindex Reset Configuration
3318
3319 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3320 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3321 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3322 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3323 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3324 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3325 Please see the various board files for examples.
3326
3327 @quotation Note
3328 To maintainers and integrators:
3329 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3330 Normally the board configuration file
3331 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3332 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3333
3334 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3335 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3336 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3337 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3338 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3339 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3340 @end quotation
3341
3342 @section Types of Reset
3343
3344 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3345 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3346 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3347
3348 @itemize @bullet
3349 @item
3350 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3351 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3352 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3353 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3354 @item
3355 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3356 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3357 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3358 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3359 @item
3360 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3361 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3362 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3363 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3364 @item
3365 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3366 several other types of reset.
3367 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3368 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3369 There may be individual module resets.
3370 @end itemize
3371
3372 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3373 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3374 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3375 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3376 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3377 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3378 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3379 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3380 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3381
3382 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3383 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3384
3385 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3386 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3387 common issues are:
3388
3389 @itemize @bullet
3390
3391 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3392 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3393 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3394 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3395 when either of those signals is not connected.
3396 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3397 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3398 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3399 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3400
3401 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3402 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3403 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3404 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3407 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3408 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3409 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3410 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3411 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3412 hardware debouncing.
3413 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3414 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3415
3416 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3417 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3418 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3419 to use push/pull output drivers.
3420 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3421 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3422 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3423 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3424
3425 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3426 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3427 issues (not limited to errata).
3428 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3429 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3430 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3431 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3432 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3433 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3434 @end itemize
3435
3436 There can also be other issues.
3437 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3438 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3439 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3440 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3441 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3442 Agreement (NDA).
3443
3444 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3445 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3446 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3447
3448 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3449 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3450
3451 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3452
3453 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3454 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3455 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3456 allowing it to be deasserted.
3457 @end deffn
3458
3459 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3460 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3461 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3462 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3463 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3464 @end deffn
3465
3466 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3467 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3468 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3469 allowing it to be deasserted.
3470 @end deffn
3471
3472 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3473 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3474 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3475 @end deffn
3476
3477 @anchor {reset_config}
3478 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3479 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3480 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3481 configuration scripts.
3482
3483 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3484 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3485 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3486 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3487 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3488 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3489 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3490 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3491
3492 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3493 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3494 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3495 -- may be specified at a time.
3496 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3497 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3498 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3499 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3500 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3501
3502 @itemize
3503 @item
3504 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3505 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3506 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3507 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3508 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3509
3510 @quotation Tip
3511 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3512 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3513 @end quotation
3514
3515 @item
3516 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3517 signal implementations.
3518 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3519 indicating everything behaves normally.
3520 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3521 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3522 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3523 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3524 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3525 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3526 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3527
3528 @item
3529 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3530 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3531 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3532 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3533 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3534 while SRST is asserted.
3535 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3536 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3537
3538 @item
3539 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3540 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3541 is required to use this option.
3542 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3543 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3544 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3545 be asserted before any target connection.
3546 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3547 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3548 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3549 @end itemize
3550
3551 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3552 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3553 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3554 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3555 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3556
3557 @itemize
3558 @item
3559 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3560 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3561 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3562 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3563
3564 @item
3565 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3566 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3567 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3568 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3569 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3570 @end itemize
3571 @end deffn
3572
3573 @section Custom Reset Handling
3574 @cindex events
3575
3576 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3577 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3578 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3579 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3580 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3581 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3582
3583 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3584 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3585 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3586 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3587 want to reset everything at once.
3588
3589 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3590 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3591 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3592 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3593 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3594 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3595 needs special attention.
3596
3597 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3598 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3599 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3600 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3601 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3602 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3603 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3604 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3605
3606 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3607 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3608 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3609 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3610 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3611
3612 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3613 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3614 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3615 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3616 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3617 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3618 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3619 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3620 or potentially some other value.
3621
3622 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3623 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3624 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3625 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3626 (or their associated targets)
3627 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3628
3629 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3630 they return.
3631 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3632 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3633 @end deffn
3634
3635 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3636 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3637 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3638 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3639 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3640 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3641 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3642 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3643 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3644 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3645 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3646 @end deffn
3647
3648 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3649 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3650 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3651 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3652 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3653 @end deffn
3654
3655
3656 @node TAP Declaration
3657 @chapter TAP Declaration
3658 @cindex TAP declaration
3659 @cindex TAP configuration
3660
3661 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3662 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3663
3664 @itemize @bullet
3665 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3666 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3667 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3668 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3669 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3670 start running that code.
3671 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3672 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3673 and missing connections.
3674 @end itemize
3675
3676 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3677 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3678 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3679 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3680 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3681
3682 @section Scan Chains
3683 @cindex scan chain
3684
3685 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3686 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3687 They also need to be added to
3688 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3689 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3690 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3691 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3692 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3693 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3694 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3695 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3696
3697 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3698 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3699 command, presented in the next chapter.
3700 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3701 debugging targets.)
3702 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3703
3704 @verbatim
3705 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3706 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3707 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3708 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3709 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3710 @end verbatim
3711
3712 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3713 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3714 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3715 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3716 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3717 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3718 until they are told to do so.
3719
3720 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3721 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3722 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3723 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3724
3725 @example
3726 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3727 @end example
3728
3729 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3730 by a given chip.
3731 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3732 and so forth.
3733 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3734 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3735 both inside a single chip and between them.
3736 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3737
3738 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3739 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3740 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3741 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3742 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3743 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3744 includes commands something like this:
3745
3746 @example
3747 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3748 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3749 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3750 @end example
3751
3752 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3753 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3754 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3755
3756 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3757 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3758 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3759 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3760 @example
3761 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3762 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3763 @}
3764 @end example
3765 @end deffn
3766
3767 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3768 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3769 and their status.
3770 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3771 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3772 but systems with a JTAG router can
3773 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3774 @end deffn
3775
3776 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3777 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3778
3779 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3780 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3781
3782 @section TAP Names
3783 @cindex dotted name
3784
3785 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3786 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3787 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3788 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3789 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3790 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3791 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3792 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3793
3794 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3795 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3796 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3797
3798 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3799
3800 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3801 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3802 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3803 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3804
3805 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3806 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3807 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3808 overridable.
3809
3810 @cindex TAP naming convention
3811 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3812 and should follow this convention:
3813
3814 @itemize @bullet
3815 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3816 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3817 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3818 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3819 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3820 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3821 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3822 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3823 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3824 with a single TAP;
3825 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3826 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3827 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3828 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3829 @end itemize
3830
3831 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3832
3833 @itemize @bullet
3834 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3835 @*The length in bits of the
3836 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3837 @end itemize
3838
3839 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3840
3841 @itemize @bullet
3842 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3843 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3844 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3845 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3846 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3847 (the TAP is linked in).
3848 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3849 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3850 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3851 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3852 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3853 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3854 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3855 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3856 values that were found but not included in the list.
3857
3858 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3859 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3860 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3861 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3862 hardware to find these values.
3863 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3864 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3865 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3866 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3867 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3868 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3869 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3870 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3871 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3872 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3873 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3874 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3875 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3876 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3877 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3878 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3879 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3880 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3881 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3882 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3883 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3884 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3885 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3886 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3887 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3888 @end itemize
3889 @end deffn
3890
3891 @section Other TAP commands
3892
3893 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3894 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3895 At this writing this TAP attribute
3896 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3897 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3898 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3899 See the next section for information about the available events.
3900
3901 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3902 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3903 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3904 @end deffn
3905
3906 @section TAP Events
3907 @cindex events
3908 @cindex TAP events
3909
3910 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3911 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3912 The other applies to debugger targets,
3913 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3914
3915 The TAP events currently defined are:
3916
3917 @itemize @bullet
3918 @item @b{post-reset}
3919 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3920 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3921 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3922 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3923 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3924
3925 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3926 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3927 of any particular target.
3928 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3929 @item @b{setup}
3930 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3931 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3932 @item @b{tap-disable}
3933 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3934 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3935 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3936 @item @b{tap-enable}
3937 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3938 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3939 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3940 @end itemize
3941
3942 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3943 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3944 contents to be accurate), you might:
3945
3946 @example
3947 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3948 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3949 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3950 @}
3951 @end example
3952
3953
3954 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3955 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3956 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3957 @cindex jrc
3958
3959 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3960 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3961 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3962 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3963 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3964
3965 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3966 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3967 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3968 be visible.
3969 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3970 ignores, such as:
3971
3972 @itemize
3973 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3974 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3975 TAPs receive new instructions.
3976 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3977 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3978 @end itemize
3979
3980 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3981 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3982 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3983 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3984
3985 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3986 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3987
3988 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3989 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3990 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3991 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3992 should define TAP event handlers using
3993 code that looks something like this:
3994
3995 @example
3996 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3997 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3998 @}
3999 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4000 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4001 @}
4002 @end example
4003
4004 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4005
4006 @example
4007 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4008 @end example
4009
4010 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4011 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4012 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4013 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4014
4015 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4016 If necessary, disables the tap
4017 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4018 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4019 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4020 and "0" if it is disabled.
4021 @end deffn
4022
4023 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4024 If necessary, enables the tap
4025 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4026 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4027 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4028 and "0" if it is disabled.
4029 @end deffn
4030
4031 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4032 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4033 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4034 and "0" if it is disabled.
4035
4036 @quotation Note
4037 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4038 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4039 @end quotation
4040 @end deffn
4041
4042 @anchor{autoprobing}
4043 @section Autoprobing
4044 @cindex autoprobe
4045 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4046
4047 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4048 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4049 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4050 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4051
4052 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4053 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4054 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4055 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4056 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4057 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4058 right when they come out of reset).
4059
4060 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4061
4062 @example
4063 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4064 reset_config trst_and_srst
4065 jtag_rclk 8
4066 @end example
4067
4068 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4069 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4070
4071 @enumerate
4072 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4073 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4074 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4075 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4076 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4077 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4078 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4079 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4080 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4081 that is discovered.
4082 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4083 register, it will report it.
4084 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4085 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4086 @end enumerate
4087
4088 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4089 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4090 that's a bit more complex:
4091
4092 @example
4093 clock speed 8 kHz
4094 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4095 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4096 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4097 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4098 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4099 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4100 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4101 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4102 @end example
4103
4104 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4105 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4106 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4107 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4108 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4109 and so forth.
4110
4111 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4112 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4113 @cindex DAP declaration
4114
4115 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4116 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4117 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4118 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4119 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4120
4121 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4122
4123 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4124 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4125 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4126 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4127 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4128
4129 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4130
4131 @itemize @bullet
4132 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4133 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4134 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4135 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4136 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4137 @end itemize
4138 @end deffn
4139
4140 @deffn Command {dap names}
4141 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4142 for TCL scripting.
4143 @end deffn
4144
4145 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4146 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4147 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4148 @end deffn
4149
4150 @deffn Command {dap init}
4151 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4152 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4153 initialization, too.
4154 @end deffn
4155
4156 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4157
4158 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4159 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4160 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4161 @end deffn
4162
4163 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4164 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4165 @end deffn
4166
4167 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4168 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4169 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4170 or set a new value @var{value}.
4171 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4172 @end deffn
4173
4174 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4175 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4176 @end deffn
4177
4178 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4179 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4180 value @var{value}.
4181
4182 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4183 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4184 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4185
4186 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4187 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4188 @end deffn
4189
4190 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4191 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4192 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4193 @end deffn
4194
4195 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4196 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4197 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4198 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4199 @end deffn
4200
4201 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4202 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4203
4204 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4205 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4206 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4207 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4208 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4209 for details.
4210
4211 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4212 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4213 the pattern:
4214 @example
4215 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4216 @end example
4217
4218 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4219 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4220 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4221 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4222 @example
4223 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4224 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4225 @end example
4226
4227 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4228 @example
4229 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4230 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4231 @end example
4232
4233 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4234 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4235
4236 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4237 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4238 example with a proper dap name:
4239 @example
4240 xxx.dap apcsw default
4241 @end example
4242 @end deffn
4243
4244 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4245 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4246 Disabled by default
4247 @end deffn
4248
4249
4250 @node CPU Configuration
4251 @chapter CPU Configuration
4252 @cindex GDB target
4253
4254 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4255 You can also access these targets without GDB
4256 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4257 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4258 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4259 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4260
4261 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4262 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4263
4264 @section Target List
4265 @cindex target, current
4266 @cindex target, list
4267
4268 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4269 where each member has a name.
4270 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4271 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4272 (plural!) command.
4273 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4274 look like with more than one:
4275 @verbatim
4276 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4277 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4278 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4279 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4280 @end verbatim
4281
4282 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4283 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4284 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4285 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4286 space seen by that current target.
4287 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4288 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4289 are examples; and there are many more.
4290
4291 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4292
4293 @deffn Command {target current}
4294 Returns the name of the current target.
4295 @end deffn
4296
4297 @deffn Command {target names}
4298 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4299 @example
4300 foreach t [target names] @{
4301 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4302 @}
4303 @end example
4304 @end deffn
4305
4306 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4307 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4308
4309 @deffn Command targets [name]
4310 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4311 command names are singular.}
4312
4313 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4314 targets in a user friendly form.
4315
4316 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4317 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4318 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4319 @end deffn
4320
4321 @section Target CPU Types
4322 @cindex target type
4323 @cindex CPU type
4324
4325 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4326 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4327 when calling @command{target create}.
4328 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4329 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4330 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4331 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4332 what core-specific commands may be available
4333 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4334 and more.
4335
4336 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4337 since there's a command to list them.
4338
4339 @anchor{targettypes}
4340 @deffn Command {target types}
4341 Lists all supported target types.
4342 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4343
4344 @itemize @bullet
4345 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4346 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4347 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4348 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4349 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4350 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4351 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4352 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4353 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4354 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4355 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4356 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4357 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4358 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4359 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4360 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4361 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4362 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4363 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4364 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4365 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4366 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4367 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4368 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4369 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4370 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4371 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4372 @itemize @minus
4373 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4374 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4375 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4376 @end itemize
4377 And two debug interfaces cores:
4378 @itemize @minus
4379 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4380 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4381 @end itemize
4382 @end itemize
4383 @end deffn
4384
4385 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4386 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4387 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4388 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4389 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4390 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4391 reflect design generations;
4392 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4393 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4394
4395 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4396 @section Target Configuration
4397
4398 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4399 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4400 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4401 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4402 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4403
4404 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4405 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4406 optional parts.
4407 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4408 command, created as part of target creation.
4409
4410 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4411 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4412 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4413 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4414 to be much more board-specific.
4415 The key steps you use might look something like this
4416
4417 @example
4418 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4419 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4420 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4421 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4422 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4423 @end example
4424
4425 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4426 on-chip SRAM.
4427 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4428 writes to target memory;
4429 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4430 GDB memory checksumming;
4431 and more.
4432
4433 @quotation Warning
4434 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4435 inaccessible when application code
4436 (such as an operating system)
4437 enables or disables the MMU.
4438 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4439 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4440 easy access to other addresses needed.
4441 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4442 @end quotation
4443
4444 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4445 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4446 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4447 controllers.
4448 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4449 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4450 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4451
4452 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4453 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4454 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4455 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4456 purposes including additional configuration.
4457
4458 @itemize @bullet
4459 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4460 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4461 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4462 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4463
4464 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4465 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4466 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4467 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4468 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4469 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4470 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4471
4472 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4473 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4474 @end itemize
4475 @end deffn
4476
4477 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4478 The options accepted by this command may also be
4479 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4480 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4481 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4482
4483 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4484 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4485 and changing its endianness.
4486
4487 @itemize @bullet
4488
4489 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4490 used to access this target.
4491
4492 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4493 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4494 create and manage DAP instances.
4495
4496 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4497 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4498
4499 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4500 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4501 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4502 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4503 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4504 same event name assigns only one handler.
4505
4506 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4507 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4508
4509 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4510 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4511 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4512 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4513 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4514 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4515 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4516
4517 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4518 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4519 or virtual address is being used.
4520
4521 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4522 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4523
4524 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4525 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4526 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4527 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4528 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4529
4530 @anchor{rtostype}
4531 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4532 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4533 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4534 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4535 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4536
4537 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4538 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4539 access the target for debugging.
4540
4541 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4542 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4543 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4544 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4545
4546 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4547 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4548 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4549 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4550 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4551
4552 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4553 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4554 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4555 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4556 command @command{gdb_port}.
4557 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4558 @end itemize
4559 @end deffn
4560
4561 @section Other $target_name Commands
4562 @cindex object command
4563
4564 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4565 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4566
4567 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4568 Once a button is created a button
4569 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4570 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4571 configure it like this:
4572
4573 @example
4574 # Create
4575 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4576 # Modify
4577 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4578 # Query
4579 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4580 # Report
4581 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4582 @end example
4583
4584 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4585 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4586
4587 @example
4588 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4589 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4590 @end example
4591
4592 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4593
4594 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4595 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4596 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4597 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4598 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4599 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4600 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4601 They are not otherwise documented here.
4602 @end deffn
4603
4604 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4605 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4606 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4607 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4608 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4609 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4610 the target side uses raw memory.
4611
4612 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4613 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4614 The script orientation comes from working with data
4615 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4616 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4617 and neither store nor return those values.
4618
4619 @itemize
4620 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4621 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4622 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4623 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4624 @end itemize
4625 @end deffn
4626
4627 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4628 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4629 @command{$target_name configure}
4630 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4631 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4632 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4633 There are a few special cases:
4634
4635 @itemize @bullet
4636 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4637 event named @var{event_name}.
4638 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4639 two parameters.
4640 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4641 This is a special case because this is set using
4642 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4643 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4644 @end itemize
4645
4646 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4647 all the targets you might use something like this:
4648
4649 @example
4650 foreach name [target names] @{
4651 set y [$name cget -endian]
4652 set z [$name cget -type]
4653 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4654 $x $name $y $z]
4655 @}
4656 @end example
4657 @end deffn
4658
4659 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4660 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4661 Displays the current target state:
4662 @code{debug-running},
4663 @code{halted},
4664 @code{reset},
4665 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4666 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4667 @end deffn
4668
4669 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4670 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4671 currently associated with this target.
4672 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4673 @end deffn
4674
4675 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4676 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4677 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4678 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4679 @end deffn
4680
4681 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4682 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4683 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4684 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4685 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4686 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4687 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4688 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4689 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4693 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4694 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4695 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4696 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4697 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4698 @end deffn
4699
4700 @anchor{targetevents}
4701 @section Target Events
4702 @cindex target events
4703 @cindex events
4704 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4705 For example:
4706 @itemize @bullet
4707 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4708 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4709 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4710 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4711 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4712 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4713 to set up system clocks or
4714 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4715 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4716 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4717 @end itemize
4718
4719 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4720 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4721 @command{target create ... -event}.
4722
4723 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4724 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4725 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4726
4727 @example
4728 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4729 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4730 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4731 @}
4732 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4733 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4734 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4735 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4736 @}
4737 @end example
4738
4739 The following target events are defined:
4740
4741 @itemize @bullet
4742 @item @b{debug-halted}
4743 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4744 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4745 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4746 @item @b{early-halted}
4747 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4748 @item @b{examine-start}
4749 @* Before target examine is called.
4750 @item @b{examine-end}
4751 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4752 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4753 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4754 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4755 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4756 connect GDB to running target.
4757 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4758 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4759 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4760 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4761 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4762 is in RAM or read only memory.
4763 Default is @code{halt}
4764 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4765 @* When GDB disconnects
4766 @item @b{gdb-end}
4767 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4768 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4769 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4770 @code{reset init})
4771 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4772 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4773 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4774 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4775 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4776 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4777 @item @b{gdb-start}
4778 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4779 @item @b{halted}
4780 @* The target has halted
4781 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4782 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4783 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4784 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4785 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4786 @item @b{reset-assert}
4787 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4788 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4789 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4790 it instead of asserting SRST.
4791 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4792 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4793 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4794 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4795 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4796 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4797 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4798 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4799 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4800 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4801 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4802 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4803 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4804 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4805 released on the scan chain.
4806 @item @b{reset-end}
4807 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4808 @item @b{reset-init}
4809 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4810 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4811
4812 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4813 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4814 multiplexing, and so on.
4815 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4816 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4817 @item @b{reset-start}
4818 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4819 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4820
4821 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4822 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4823 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4824 @item @b{resume-start}
4825 @* Before any target is resumed
4826 @item @b{resume-end}
4827 @* After all targets have resumed
4828 @item @b{resumed}
4829 @* Target has resumed
4830 @item @b{trace-config}
4831 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4832 @end itemize
4833
4834 @node Flash Commands
4835 @chapter Flash Commands
4836
4837 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4838 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4839 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4840 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4841 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4842 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4843 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4844 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4845 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4846
4847 Flash Steps:
4848 @enumerate
4849 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4850 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4851 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4852 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4853 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4854 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4855 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4856 @item GDB Flashing
4857 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4858 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4859 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4860 @end enumerate
4861
4862 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4863 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4864 so that it can't boot.
4865 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4866 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4867
4868 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4869 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4870 @cindex flash configuration
4871
4872 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4873 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4874 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4875 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4876 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4877 see the driver-specific documentation.
4878
4879 @itemize @bullet
4880 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4881 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4882 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4883 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4884 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4885 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4886 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4887 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4888 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4889 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4890 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4891 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4892 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4893 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4894 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4895 commands to the flash controller.
4896 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4897 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4898 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4899 for more information.
4900 @end itemize
4901 @quotation Note
4902 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4903 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4904 @end quotation
4905 @end deffn
4906
4907 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4908 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4909 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4910 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4911 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4912 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4913 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4914 @end deffn
4915
4916 @deffn Command {flash list}
4917 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4918 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4919 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4920 @end deffn
4921
4922 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4923 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4924 depends on the flash type.
4925 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4926 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4927 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4928 but most don't bother.
4929 @end deffn
4930
4931 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4932 @cindex flash erasing
4933 @cindex flash reading
4934 @cindex flash writing
4935 @cindex flash programming
4936 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4937
4938 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4939 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4940 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4941 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4942 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4943
4944 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4945 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4946 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4947 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4948 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4949
4950 @quotation Note
4951 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4952 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4953 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4954 back to a flash bank.
4955 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4956 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4957 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4958 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4959 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4960 @end quotation
4961
4962 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4963 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4964 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4965 disabled first.
4966 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4967 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4968 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4969
4970 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4971 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4972 up to and including @var{last}.
4973 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4974 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4975 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4976 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4977 @end deffn
4978
4979 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4980 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4981 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4982 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4983 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4984 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4985 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4986 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4987 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4988 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4989 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4990 before erase starts.
4991 @end deffn
4992
4993 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4994 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4995 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4996 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4997 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4998 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4999 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5000 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5001 before issuing this command.
5002 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5003 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5004 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5005 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5006 @end deffn
5007 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5008
5009 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5010 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5011 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5012 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5013 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5014 @end deffn
5015
5016 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5017 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5018 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5019 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5020 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5021 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5022 @end deffn
5023
5024 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5025 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5026 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5027 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5028 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5029 @end deffn
5030
5031 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5032 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5033 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5034 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5035 to the base address for each section in the image.
5036 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5037 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5038 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5039 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5040 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5041 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5042 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5043 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5044 each image section.
5045
5046 @quotation Warning
5047 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5048 data you want to preserve.
5049 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5050 sections might be erased with no notice.
5051 @itemize
5052 @item
5053 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5054 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5055 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5056 @item
5057 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5058 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5059 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5060 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5061 @end itemize
5062 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5063 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5064 @end quotation
5065
5066 @end deffn
5067
5068 @section Other Flash commands
5069 @cindex flash protection
5070
5071 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5072 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5073 and display that status.
5074 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5075 @end deffn
5076
5077 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5078 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5079 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5080
5081 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5082 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5083 and possibly stale information.
5084 @end deffn
5085
5086 @anchor{flashprotect}
5087 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5088 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5089 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5090 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5091 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5092 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5093 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5094 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5095 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5096 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5097 @end deffn
5098
5099 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5100 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5101 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5102 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5103 @end deffn
5104
5105 @anchor{program}
5106 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5107 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5108 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5109 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5110 @end deffn
5111
5112 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5113 @section Flash Driver List
5114 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5115 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5116 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5117
5118 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5119 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5120 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5121
5122 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5123
5124 @itemize
5125 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5126 @end itemize
5127
5128 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5129 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5130 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5131 @example
5132 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5133 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5134 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5135 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5136 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5137 @end example
5138 @end deffn
5139
5140 @subsection External Flash
5141
5142 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5143 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5144 @cindex CFI
5145 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5146 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5147 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5148 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5149 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5150 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5151 configure a bus and its timings), or
5152 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5153 on the flash chip.
5154 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5155 speed up operation.
5156
5157 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5158
5159 @itemize
5160 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5161 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5162 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5163 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5164 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5165 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5166 @end itemize
5167
5168 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5169 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5170
5171 @example
5172 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5173 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5174 @end example
5175
5176 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5177 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5178 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5179
5180 @example
5181 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5182 @end example
5183
5184 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5185 @end deffn
5186
5187 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5188 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5189 @cindex SPI
5190 @cindex jtagspi
5191 @cindex bscan_spi
5192 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5193 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5194 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5195 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5196 accessed through JTAG.
5197
5198 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5199 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5200 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5201 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5202 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5203 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5204
5205 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5206 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5207 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5208 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5209 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5210 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5211 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5212 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5213
5214 @itemize
5215 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5216 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5217 @var{USER1} instruction.
5218 @end itemize
5219
5220 @example
5221 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5222 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5223 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5224 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5225 @end example
5226 @end deffn
5227
5228 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5229 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5230 @cindex xcf
5231 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5232 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5233 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5234 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5235 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5236
5237 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5238 command accepts additional parameters:
5239 @itemize
5240 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5241 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5242 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5243 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5244 in master mode.
5245 @end itemize
5246 @example
5247 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5248 @end example
5249 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5250 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5251 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5252 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5253 dedicated sector.
5254 @end deffn
5255
5256 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5257 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5258 button.
5259 @example
5260 xcf configure 0
5261 @end example
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 Additional driver notes:
5265 @itemize
5266 @item Only single revision supported.
5267 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5268 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5269 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5270 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5271 @end itemize
5272 @end deffn
5273
5274 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5275 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5276 @cindex SPIFI
5277 @cindex lpcspifi
5278 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5279 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5280 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5281
5282 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5283 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5284 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5285 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5286 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5287
5288 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5289 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5290 are configured by the driver.
5291
5292 @example
5293 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5294 @end example
5295
5296 @end deffn
5297
5298 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5299 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5300 @cindex SMI
5301 @cindex stmsmi
5302 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5303 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5304 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5305 SPI flash devices.
5306 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5307 flash devices can be connected.
5308
5309 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5310 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5311 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5312 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5313 the flash content.
5314
5315 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5316 to identify the memory bank.
5317 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5318 flash size, are detected automatically.
5319
5320 @example
5321 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5322 @end example
5323
5324 @end deffn
5325
5326 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5327 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5328 Microcontroller platform.
5329
5330 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5331 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5332
5333 @example
5334 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5335 @end example
5336
5337 @end deffn
5338
5339 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5340 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5341 @cindex ath79
5342 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5343 chip selects.
5344 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5345 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5346 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5347 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5348 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5349 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5350
5351 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5352 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5353 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5354 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5355 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5356 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5357 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5358 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5359 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5360 with the default CS0.
5361 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5362 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5363 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5364
5365 @example
5366 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5367
5368 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5369 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5370 # banks.
5371 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5372 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5373 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5374 @end example
5375
5376 @end deffn
5377
5378 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5379 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5380 @cindex fespi
5381
5382 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5383
5384 @example
5385 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5386 @end example
5387 @end deffn
5388
5389 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5390
5391 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5392 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5393 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5394 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5395 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5396 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5397
5398 @example
5399 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5400 @end example
5401 @end deffn
5402
5403 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5404 @cindex ambiqmicro
5405 @cindex apollo
5406 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5407 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5408 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5409 with the target using SWD.
5410
5411 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5412 the device class of the MCU.
5413 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5414 to set up the flash banks.
5415 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5416 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5417
5418 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5419 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5420 and the second bank starts after the first.
5421
5422 @example
5423 # Flash bank 0
5424 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5425 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5426 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5427 $_TARGETNAME
5428 @end example
5429
5430 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5431 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5432 are available to the user.
5433
5434 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5435
5436 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5437 Erase entire bank.
5438 @end deffn
5439 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5440 Erase device pages.
5441 @end deffn
5442 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5443 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5444 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5445 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5446 the flash.
5447 @end deffn
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @anchor{at91samd}
5451 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5452 @cindex at91samd
5453 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5454 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5455
5456 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5457
5458 The devices have one flash bank:
5459
5460 @example
5461 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5462 @end example
5463
5464 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5465 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5466 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5467 processor to be halted.
5468 @end deffn
5469
5470 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5471 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5472 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5473 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5474 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5475 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5476
5477 @example
5478 at91samd set-security enable
5479 @end example
5480 @end deffn
5481
5482 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5483 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5484 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5485 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5486 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5487 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5488 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5489 in order to disable this feature.
5490
5491 @example
5492 at91samd eeprom
5493 at91samd eeprom 1024
5494 @end example
5495 @end deffn
5496
5497 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5498 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5499 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5500 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5501 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5502 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5503
5504 @example
5505 at91samd bootloader
5506 at91samd bootloader 16384
5507 @end example
5508 @end deffn
5509
5510 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5511 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5512 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5513 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5514 @end deffn
5515
5516 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5517 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5518 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5519 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5520 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5521 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5522 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5523 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5524
5525 @example
5526 # Read user row
5527 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5528 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5529 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5530 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5531 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5532 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5533 @end example
5534 @end deffn
5535
5536 @end deffn
5537
5538 @anchor{at91sam3}
5539 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5540 @cindex at91sam3
5541 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5542 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5543 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5544 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5545 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5546 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5547 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5548 chips are confirmed.}
5549
5550 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5551 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5552 the following fixed locations:
5553
5554 @example
5555 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5556 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5557 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5558 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5559 @end example
5560
5561 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5562 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5563 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5564
5565 @itemize
5566 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5567 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5568 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5569 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5570 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5571 @end itemize
5572
5573 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5574
5575 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5576 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5577 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5578 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5579 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5580 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5581 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5582
5583 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5584 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5585 @end deffn
5586
5587 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5588 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5589 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5590 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5591 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5592 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5593 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5594 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5598 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5599 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5600 @end deffn
5601 @end deffn
5602
5603 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5604 @cindex at91sam4
5605 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5606 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5607 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5608 @end deffn
5609
5610 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5611 @cindex at91sam4l
5612 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5613 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5614 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5615
5616 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5617 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5618 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5619 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5620 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5621 @end deffn
5622 @end deffn
5623
5624 @anchor{atsame5}
5625 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5626 @cindex atsame5
5627 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5628 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5629 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5630
5631 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5632 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5633 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5634
5635 @example
5636 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5637 @end example
5638
5639 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5640 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5641 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5642 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5643 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5644 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5645
5646 @example
5647 atsame5 bootloader
5648 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5649 @end example
5650 @end deffn
5651
5652 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5653 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5654 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5655 processor to be halted.
5656 @end deffn
5657
5658 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5659 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5660 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5661 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5665 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5666 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5667 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5668 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5669 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5670 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5671 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5672
5673 @example
5674 # Read
5675 >atsame5 userpage
5676 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5677 # Write
5678 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5679 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5680 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5681 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5682 @end example
5683 @end deffn
5684
5685 @end deffn
5686
5687 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5688 @cindex atsamv
5689 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5690 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5691 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5692 @end deffn
5693
5694 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5695 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5696 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5697 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5698 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5699
5700 @example
5701 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5702 @end example
5703
5704 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5705 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5706
5707 @itemize
5708 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5709 @item @var{banks}
5710 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5711 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5712 @item @var{pages_size}
5713 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5714 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5715 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5716 @end itemize
5717
5718 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5719 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5720 will be autoconfigured.
5721 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5722
5723 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5724 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5725 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5726 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5727 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5728
5729 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5730 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5731 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5732 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5733 are not truly general purpose).
5734 @quotation Note
5735 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5736 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5737 @end quotation
5738 @end deffn
5739 @end deffn
5740
5741 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5742 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5743 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5744 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5745 @end deffn
5746
5747 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5748 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5749 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5750 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5751
5752 @example
5753 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5754 @end example
5755
5756 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5757 each single sector one by one.
5758
5759 @example
5760 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5761 @end example
5762
5763 @example
5764 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5765 @end example
5766
5767 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5768 @end deffn
5769
5770 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5771 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5772 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5773 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5774 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5775 starts at address 0.
5776
5777 @example
5778 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5779 @end example
5780 @end deffn
5781
5782 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5783 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5784 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5785 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5786 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5787 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5788 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5789 and programming the serial flash.
5790
5791 @example
5792 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5793 @end example
5794 @end deffn
5795
5796 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5797 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5798 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5799 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5800 autoconfigures itself.
5801 @example
5802 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5803 @end example
5804 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5805 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5806 this via the following command:
5807 @example
5808 efm32 debuglock num
5809 @end example
5810 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5811 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5812 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5813 supported.}
5814 @end deffn
5815
5816 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5817 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5818 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5819 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5820 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5821 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5822
5823 @example
5824 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5825 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5826 @end example
5827
5828 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5829 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5833 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5834 is an uncommon operation.}
5835 @end deffn
5836 @end deffn
5837
5838 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5839 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5840 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5841 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5842 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5843 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5844 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5845
5846 @example
5847 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5848 @end example
5849 @end deffn
5850
5851 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5852 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5853 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5854 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5855 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5856 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5857 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5858 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5859 characters) ignored.
5860
5861 @example
5862 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5863 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5864 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5865 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5866 @end example
5867 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5868 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5869 @end deffn
5870
5871 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5872 @cindex kinetis
5873 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5874 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5875 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5876 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5877 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5878 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5879
5880 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5881 @itemize
5882 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5883 @end itemize
5884
5885 @example
5886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5887 @end example
5888
5889 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5890 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5891 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5892 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5893 @end deffn
5894
5895 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5896 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5897 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5898 set by 'flash protect' command.
5899 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5900 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5901 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5902 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5903 with the rest of a flash image.
5904 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5908 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5909 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5913 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5914 @end deffn
5915
5916 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5917 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5918 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5919 @end deffn
5920
5921 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5922 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5923 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5924 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5925 command completes.
5926 @end deffn
5927
5928 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5929 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5930 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5931 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5932 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5933
5934 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5935 Program Partition command.
5936
5937 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5938 Reset the device after partition setting.
5939
5940 Show partition size:
5941 @example
5942 kinetis nvm_partition info
5943 @end example
5944
5945 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5946 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5947 @example
5948 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5949 @end example
5950
5951 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5952 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5953 @example
5954 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5955 @end example
5956 @end deffn
5957
5958 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5959 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5960 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5961 @end deffn
5962
5963 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5964 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5965 Command disables watchdog timer.
5966 @end deffn
5967 @end deffn
5968
5969 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5970 @cindex kinetis_ke
5971 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5972 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5973 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5974 autoconfigures itself.
5975 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5976
5977 @example
5978 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5979 @end example
5980
5981 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5982 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5983 @end deffn
5984
5985 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5986 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5987 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5988 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5989 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5990 @end deffn
5991
5992 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5993 Command disables watchdog timer.
5994 @end deffn
5995 @end deffn
5996
5997 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5998 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5999 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6000 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6001 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6002
6003 @quotation Note
6004 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6005 driver:
6006 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6007 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6008 @end quotation
6009
6010 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6011 which must appear in the following order:
6012
6013 @itemize
6014 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6015 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6016 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6017 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6018 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6019 LPC43x[2357])
6020 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6021 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6022 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6023 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6024 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6025 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6026 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6027 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6028 at which the core is running
6029 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6030 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6031 @quotation Note
6032 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6033 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6034 However, if you do provide it,
6035 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6036 @end quotation
6037 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6038 ROM IAP entry point.
6039 @end itemize
6040
6041 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6042
6043 @example
6044 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6045 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6046 @end example
6047
6048 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6049 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6050 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6051 @end deffn
6052 @end deffn
6053
6054 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6055 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6056 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6057 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6058 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6059 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6060
6061 @example
6062 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6063 @end example
6064 @end deffn
6065
6066 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6067 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6068 from NXP.
6069
6070 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6071 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6072 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6073 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6074 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6075 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6076 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6077 you start the PLL.
6078
6079 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6080
6081 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6082 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6083 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6084
6085 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6086 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6087 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6088 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6089 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6090 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6091 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6092
6093 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6094 @example
6095 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6096 @end example
6097
6098 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6099 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6100 @code{flash banks} command.
6101
6102 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6103 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6104 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6105 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6106 a known signature.
6107 Example:
6108 @example
6109 lpc2900 signature 0
6110 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6111 @end example
6112 @end deffn
6113
6114 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6115 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6116 saves it to a file in binary format.
6117 Example:
6118 @example
6119 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6120 @end example
6121 @end deffn
6122
6123 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6124 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6125 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6126 command:
6127
6128 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6129 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6130 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6131 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6132
6133 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6134 Example:
6135 @example
6136 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6137 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6138 @end example
6139 @end deffn
6140
6141 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6142 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6143 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6144 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6145 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6146 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6147 912 bytes.
6148 @quotation Attention
6149 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6150 @end quotation
6151 Example:
6152 @example
6153 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6154 @end example
6155 @end deffn
6156
6157 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6158 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6159 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6160 after the next power cycle.
6161 @quotation Attention
6162 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6163 @end quotation
6164 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6165 Example:
6166 @example
6167 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6168 flash info 0
6169 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6170 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6171 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6172 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6173 @end example
6174 @end deffn
6175
6176 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6177 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6178 effective after the next power cycle.
6179 @quotation Attention
6180 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6181 @end quotation
6182 Examples:
6183 @example
6184 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6185 @end example
6186 @end deffn
6187 @end deffn
6188
6189 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6190 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6191 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6192 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6193
6194 @example
6195 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6196 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6197 @end example
6198
6199 @itemize @bullet
6200 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6201 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6202 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6203 @end itemize
6204
6205 Example usage:
6206 @example
6207 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6208 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6209 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6210 @} else @{
6211 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6212 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6213 @}
6214 @end example
6215 @end deffn
6216
6217 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6218 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6219 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6220 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6221 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6222 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6223
6224 @example
6225 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6226 @end example
6227
6228 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6229 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6230 only the main program flash.
6231
6232 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6233 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6234 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6238 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6239 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6240 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6241
6242 To erase and program the BSL:
6243 @example
6244 msp432 bsl unlock
6245 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6246 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6247 msp432 bsl lock
6248 @end example
6249 @end deffn
6250 @end deffn
6251
6252 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6253 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6254 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6255 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6256 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6257 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6258 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6259 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6260 also have division into regions: main and info.
6261 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6262 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6263
6264 @example
6265 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6266 @end example
6267
6268 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6269
6270 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6271 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6272 @end deffn
6273
6274 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6275 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6276 @end deffn
6277
6278 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6279 Erase all userflash including info region.
6280 @end deffn
6281
6282 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6283 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6284 @end deffn
6285
6286 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6287 Check sectors protect.
6288 @end deffn
6289
6290 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6291 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6292 @end deffn
6293
6294 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6295 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6299 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6300 @end deffn
6301
6302 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6303 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6304 @end deffn
6305
6306 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6307 Show information about flash driver.
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @end deffn
6311
6312 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6313 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6314 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6315 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6316 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6317
6318 @example
6319 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6320 @end example
6321
6322 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6323
6324 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6325 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6326 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6327 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6328 code.
6329 @end deffn
6330
6331 @end deffn
6332
6333 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6334 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6335 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6336
6337 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6338 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6339 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6340 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6341
6342 @example
6343 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6344 @end example
6345 @end deffn
6346
6347 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6348 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6349 and integrate flash memory.
6350
6351 @example
6352 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6353 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6354 @end example
6355
6356 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6357 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6358 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6359 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6360 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6361 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6362 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6363 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6364 @end deffn
6365 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6366 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6367 This will remove any Code Protection.
6368 @end deffn
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6372 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6373 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6374 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6375 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6376
6377 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6378 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6379
6380 @example
6381 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6382 @end example
6383
6384 psoc4-specific commands
6385 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6386 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6387
6388 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6389 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6390
6391 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6392 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6393 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6394
6395 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6399 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6400
6401 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6402 @end deffn
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6406 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6407 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6408 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6409 apart from the base address.
6410
6411 @example
6412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6413 @end example
6414
6415 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6416 @quotation Attention
6417 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6418 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6419 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6420 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6421 @end quotation
6422
6423 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6424
6425 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6426 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6427 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6428 @end deffn
6429 @end deffn
6430
6431 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6432 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6433 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6434 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6435 apart from the base address.
6436
6437 @example
6438 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6439 @end example
6440 @end deffn
6441
6442 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6443 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6444 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6445 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6446
6447 @example
6448 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6449 @end example
6450
6451 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6452
6453 @itemize
6454 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6455 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6456 @end itemize
6457
6458 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6459
6460 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6461 @quotation Attention
6462 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6463 after successful write.
6464 @end quotation
6465 @end deffn
6466
6467 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6468 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6469 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6470 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6471
6472 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6473 @itemize @bullet
6474 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6475 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6476 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6477 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6478 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6479 row size: 512 bytes.
6480 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6481 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6482 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6483 operation will erase row automatically.
6484 @end itemize
6485
6486 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6487 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6488
6489 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6490
6491 @example
6492 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6493 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6494 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6495 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6496 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6497 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6498
6499 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6500 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6501 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6502 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6503 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6504 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6505 @end example
6506
6507 psoc6-specific commands
6508 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6509 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6510 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6511 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6512 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6513 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6514 @end deffn
6515
6516 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6517 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6518 by @command{flash banks}.
6519 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6520 @end deffn
6521 @end deffn
6522
6523 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6524 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6525 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6526 and SWD interface.
6527 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6528 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6529
6530 @example
6531 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6532 @end example
6533
6534 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6535
6536 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6537 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6538 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6542 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6543 @end deffn
6544 @end deffn
6545
6546 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6547 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6548 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6549 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6550 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6551
6552 @example
6553 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6554 @end example
6555
6556 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6557 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6558 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6559 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6560 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6561 disabled.
6562
6563 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6564 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6565 @quotation Warning
6566 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6567 applied to all of them.
6568 @end quotation
6569 @end deffn
6570 @end deffn
6571
6572 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6573 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6574 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6575 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6576 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6577
6578 @example
6579 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6580 @end example
6581
6582 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6583 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6584 the flash driver.
6585
6586 @example
6587 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6588 @end example
6589
6590 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6591 as per the following example.
6592 @example
6593 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6594 @end example
6595
6596 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6597
6598 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6599 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6600 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6601 @end deffn
6602
6603 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6604 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6605 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6606 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6607 @end deffn
6608
6609 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6610 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6611 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6612 @end deffn
6613
6614 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6615 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6616 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6617 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6618 @end deffn
6619
6620 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6621 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6622 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6623 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6624 @end deffn
6625
6626 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6627 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6628 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6629 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6630 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6631 @end deffn
6632 @end deffn
6633
6634 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6635 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6636 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6637 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6638 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6639
6640 @example
6641 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6642 @end example
6643
6644 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6645 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6646 the flash driver.
6647
6648 @example
6649 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6650 @end example
6651
6652 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6653
6654 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6655 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6657 @end deffn
6658
6659 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6660 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6661 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6662 @end deffn
6663
6664 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6665 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6666 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6670 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6671 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6675 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6676 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6677 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6678 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6679 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6680 @end deffn
6681
6682 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6683 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6684 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6685 @end deffn
6686 @end deffn
6687
6688 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6689 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6690 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6691 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6692 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6693
6694 @example
6695 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6696 @end example
6697
6698 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6699 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6700 the flash driver.
6701
6702 @example
6703 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6704 @end example
6705
6706 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6707
6708 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6709 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6710 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6711 @end deffn
6712
6713 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6714 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6715 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6719 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6720 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6721 @end deffn
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6725 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6726 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6727 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6728 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6729
6730 @example
6731 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6732 @end example
6733
6734 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6735 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6736 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6737 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6738 second bank.
6739
6740 @example
6741 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6742 @end example
6743
6744 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6745
6746 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6747 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6748 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6749 @end deffn
6750
6751 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6752 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6753 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6754 @end deffn
6755
6756 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6757 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6758 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6759 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6761 @end deffn
6762 @end deffn
6763
6764 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6765 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6766 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6767 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6768 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6769
6770 @example
6771 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6772 @end example
6773
6774 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6775 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6776 the flash driver.
6777
6778 @example
6779 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6780 @end example
6781
6782 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6783
6784 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6785 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6786 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6790 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6791 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6795 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6796 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6800 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6801 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6802 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6803
6804 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6805 @example
6806 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6807 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6808 @end example
6809
6810 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6811 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6812 @end deffn
6813
6814 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6815 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6816 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6817 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6818 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6819
6820 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6821 @example
6822 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6823 @end example
6824
6825 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6826 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6827 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6828 @end deffn
6829
6830 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6831 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6832 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6833 @end deffn
6834 @end deffn
6835
6836 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6837 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6838 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6839 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6840 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6841
6842 @example
6843 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6844 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6845 @end example
6846
6847 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6848 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6849 for the specified flash bank.
6850 @end deffn
6851 @end deffn
6852
6853 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6854 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6855 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6856 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6857 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6858
6859 @example
6860 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6861 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6862 @end example
6863
6864 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6865 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6866 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6867
6868 @itemize @bullet
6869 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6870 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6871 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6872 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6873 @end itemize
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @end deffn
6877
6878 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6879 @cindex str9xpec
6880
6881 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6882 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6883 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6884 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6885
6886 Here is some background info to help
6887 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6888 the str9:
6889 @enumerate
6890 @item
6891 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6892 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6893 @item
6894 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6895 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6896 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6897 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6898 @end enumerate
6899
6900 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6901 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6902 configured for flash bank 0.
6903 @example
6904 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6905 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6906 jtag_reset 0 1
6907 # turn off target polling
6908 poll off
6909 # disable str9 core
6910 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6911 # read option bytes
6912 str9xpec options_read 0
6913 # re-enable str9 core
6914 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6915 poll on
6916 reset halt
6917 @end example
6918 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6919 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6920 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6921 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6922
6923 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6924
6925 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6926 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6927 @end deffn
6928
6929 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6930 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6931 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6935 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6936 erase the device.
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6940 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6941 @end deffn
6942
6943 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6944 Configure str9 boot bank.
6945 @end deffn
6946
6947 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6948 Configure str9 lvd source.
6949 @end deffn
6950
6951 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6952 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6953 @end deffn
6954
6955 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6956 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6957 @end deffn
6958
6959 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6960 Read str9 option bytes.
6961 @end deffn
6962
6963 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6964 Write str9 option bytes.
6965 @end deffn
6966
6967 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6968 unlock str9 device.
6969 @end deffn
6970
6971 @end deffn
6972
6973 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6974 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6975 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6976 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6977
6978 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6979
6980 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6981 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6985 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6986 @end deffn
6987
6988 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6989 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6990 the flash clock.
6991 @end deffn
6992 @end deffn
6993
6994 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
6995 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
6996 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
6997 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6998 correct bank config.
6999
7000 @example
7001 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7002 @end example
7003 @end deffn
7004
7005 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7006 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7007 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7011 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7012 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7013
7014 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7015
7016 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7017 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7018 @end deffn
7019
7020 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7021 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 @end deffn
7025
7026 @section NAND Flash Commands
7027 @cindex NAND
7028
7029 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7030 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7031 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7032
7033 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7034 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7035 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7036 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7037 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7038 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7039
7040 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7041 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7042 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7043 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7044 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7045 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7046 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7047 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7048 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7049 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7050
7051 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7052 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7053 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7054 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7055 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7056 every 512 bytes of data.
7057
7058 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7059 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7060 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7061 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7062 ECC mode is used.
7063
7064 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7065 @enumerate
7066 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7067 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7068 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7069 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7070 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7071 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7072 to access that device.
7073 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7074 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7075 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7076 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7077 de-brick a board.
7078 @end enumerate
7079
7080 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7081 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7082 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7083 are only 32 bits wide.
7084 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7085 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7086 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7087 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7088
7089 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7090 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7091 @cindex NAND configuration
7092
7093 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7094 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7095 OpenOCD has initialized.
7096
7097 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7098 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7099 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7100 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7101 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7102 they were a single (larger) device.
7103 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7104 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7105
7106 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7107 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7108 configuration files, not interactively.
7109
7110 @itemize @bullet
7111 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7112 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7113 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7114 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7115 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7116 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7117 commands to the NAND controller.
7118 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7119 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7120 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7121 for more information.
7122 @end itemize
7123 @end deffn
7124
7125 @deffn Command {nand list}
7126 Prints a summary of each device declared
7127 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7128 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7129 @example
7130 > nand list
7131 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7132 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7133 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7134 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7135 >
7136 @end example
7137 @end deffn
7138
7139 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7140 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7141 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7142 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7143 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7144 it with most other NAND commands.
7145 @end deffn
7146
7147 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7148
7149 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7150 @cindex NAND reading
7151 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7152 starting at the specified offset.
7153 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7154
7155 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7156 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7157
7158 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7159 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7160 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7161
7162 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7163 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7164 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7165 method which handled that error correction.
7166
7167 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7168 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7169 @itemize @bullet
7170 @item no oob_* parameter
7171 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7172 @item @code{oob_raw}
7173 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7174 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7175 spare areas associated with each data page.
7176 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7177 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7178 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7179 @item @code{oob_only}
7180 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7181 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7182 spare areas associated with each data page.
7183 @end itemize
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7187 @cindex NAND erasing
7188 @cindex NAND programming
7189 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7190 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7191 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7192 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7193 If those parameters are not specified,
7194 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7195 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7196
7197 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7198 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7199 block marker.
7200 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7201 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7205 @cindex NAND writing
7206 @cindex NAND programming
7207 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7208 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7209 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7210 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7211
7212 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7213 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7214
7215 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7216 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7217 past the end of the device.
7218 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7219 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7220 if that's being written.)
7221
7222 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7223 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7224 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7225
7226 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7227 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7228 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7229 @itemize @bullet
7230 @item no oob_* parameter
7231 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7232 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7233 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7234 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7235 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7236 @item @code{oob_only}
7237 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7238 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7239 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7240 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7241 @item @code{oob_raw}
7242 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7243 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7244 un-altered OOB.
7245 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7246 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7247 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7248 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7249 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7250 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7251 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7252 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7253 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7254 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7255 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7256 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7257 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7258 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7259 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7260 @end itemize
7261 @end deffn
7262
7263 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7264 @cindex NAND verification
7265 @cindex NAND programming
7266 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7267 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7268 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7269
7270 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7271 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7272
7273 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7274 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7275 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7276 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7277 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7278
7279 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7280 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7281 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7282
7283 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7284 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7285 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7286 be removed in a future release.
7287 @end deffn
7288
7289 @subsection Other NAND commands
7290 @cindex NAND other commands
7291
7292 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7293 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7294 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7295 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7296 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7297 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7298 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7299 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7300
7301 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7302 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7303 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7304 @end deffn
7305
7306 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7307 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7308 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7309 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7310 status for each block.
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7314 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7315 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7316
7317 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7318 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7319 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7320 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7321 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7322
7323 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7324 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7325 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7326 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7327 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7328 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7329 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7330 @end deffn
7331
7332 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7333 @subsection NAND Driver List
7334 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7335 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7336 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7337
7338 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7339 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7340 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7341 address of the ECC controller.
7342 @example
7343 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7344 @end example
7345 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7346 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7347 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7348 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7349 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7350 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7351 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7352 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7353 @end deffn
7354 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7355 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7356 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7357 @end deffn
7358
7359 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7360 properly configured for input or output.
7361 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7362 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7363 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7364 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7365 @end deffn
7366 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7367 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7368 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7369 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7370 @end deffn
7371 @end deffn
7372
7373 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7374 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7375 chips from Texas Instruments.
7376 It takes three extra parameters:
7377 address of the NAND chip;
7378 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7379 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7380 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7381 @example
7382 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7383 @end example
7384 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7385 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7386 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7387 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7388 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7389 @end deffn
7390
7391 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7392 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7393 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7394 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7395 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7396 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7397 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7398 @end deffn
7399
7400 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7401 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7402 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7403 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7404 @end deffn
7405 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7406
7407 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7408 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7409 should work for this chip as well.
7410 @end deffn
7411
7412 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7413 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7414 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7415 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7416 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7417 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7418 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7419 @example
7420 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7421 @end example
7422 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7423 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7424 without parameter query status.
7425 @end deffn
7426 @end deffn
7427
7428 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7429 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7430 parameter: the address of the controller.
7431 @example
7432 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7433 @end example
7434 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7435 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7436 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7437 change any behavior.
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7441 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7442 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7443 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7444 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7445 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7446 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7447 specialized commands.
7448 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7449 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7450 change any behavior.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @section mFlash
7454
7455 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7456 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7457
7458 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7459 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7460 address @var{base}.
7461 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7462 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7463
7464 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7465
7466 @example
7467 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7468 @end example
7469
7470 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7471
7472 @example
7473 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7474 @end example
7475 @end deffn
7476
7477 @subsection mFlash commands
7478 @cindex mFlash commands
7479
7480 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7481 Configure mflash PLL.
7482 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7483 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7484 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7485 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7486 @end deffn
7487
7488 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7489 Configure bootable option.
7490 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7491 (4kB) for boot.
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7495 Configure storage information.
7496 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7497 written.
7498 @end deffn
7499
7500 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7501 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7502 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7503 @end deffn
7504
7505 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7506 Probe mflash.
7507 @end deffn
7508
7509 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7510 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7511 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7512 @end deffn
7513
7514 @node Flash Programming
7515 @chapter Flash Programming
7516
7517 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7518 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7519 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7520
7521 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7522 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7523
7524 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7525 @enumerate
7526 @item 'init' is executed.
7527 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7528 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7529 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7530 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7531 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7532 @end enumerate
7533
7534 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7535
7536 @example
7537 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7538 # are optional parameters
7539 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7540 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7541
7542 # binary files need the flash address passing
7543 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7544 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7545 @end example
7546
7547 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7548 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7549 @cindex PLD
7550 @cindex FPGA
7551
7552 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7553 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7554 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7555 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7556 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7557 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7558 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7559
7560 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7561
7562 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7563 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7564 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7565
7566 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7567 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7568
7569 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7570 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7571 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7572 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7573 behavior.
7574 @end deffn
7575
7576 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7577 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7578 @end deffn
7579
7580 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7581 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7582 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7583 @end deffn
7584
7585 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7586
7587 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7588 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7589 that particular type of PLD.
7590
7591 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7592 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7593 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7594
7595 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7596 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7597 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7598
7599 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7600 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7601 for FPGA @var{num}.
7602 @end deffn
7603 @end deffn
7604
7605 @node General Commands
7606 @chapter General Commands
7607 @cindex commands
7608
7609 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7610 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7611 commands are documented elsewhere.
7612
7613 Intent:
7614 @itemize @bullet
7615 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7616 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7617 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7618 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7619
7620 @item @b{From the human}
7621 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7622 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7623
7624 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7625 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7626 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7627
7628 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7629 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7630 port is 5555.
7631 @end itemize
7632
7633
7634 @section Server Commands
7635
7636 @deffn {Command} exit
7637 Exits the current telnet session.
7638 @end deffn
7639
7640 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7641 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7642 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7643 Not every command provides helptext.
7644
7645 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7646 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7647 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7648 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7652 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7653 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7654 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7655 Useful in connection with script files
7656 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7657 @end deffn
7658
7659 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7660 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7661 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7662 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7663
7664 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7665 @example
7666 # redefine shutdown
7667 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7668 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7669 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7670 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7671 original_shutdown
7672 @}
7673 @end example
7674 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7675 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7676 @end deffn
7677
7678 @anchor{debuglevel}
7679 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7680 @cindex message level
7681 Display debug level.
7682 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7683 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7684 Level 0 is error messages only;
7685 level 1 adds warnings;
7686 level 2 adds informational messages;
7687 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7688 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7689 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7690 the command line along with the location of that log
7691 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7692 @xref{Running}.
7693 @end deffn
7694
7695 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7696 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7697 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7698 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7699 @example
7700 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7701 @end example
7702 @end deffn
7703
7704 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7705 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7706 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7707 @end deffn
7708
7709 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7710 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7711 @end deffn
7712
7713 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7714 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7715 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7716 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7717 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7718 @end deffn
7719
7720 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7721 @section Target State handling
7722 @cindex reset
7723 @cindex halt
7724 @cindex target initialization
7725
7726 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7727 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7728 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7729 a current target which is used to perform the
7730 various operations. The current target may be changed
7731 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7732 target which should become current.
7733
7734 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7735 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7736 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7737 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7738 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7739
7740 @emph{With no arguments}:
7741 list all available registers for the current target,
7742 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7743 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7744 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7745 are flagged as such.
7746
7747 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7748 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7749 bypassing any internal cache.
7750
7751 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7752 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7753 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7754 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7755 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7756 relevant module will flush such values.
7757
7758 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7759 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7760
7761 @example
7762 > reg
7763 ===== ARM registers
7764 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7765 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7766 (2) r2 (/32)
7767 ...
7768 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7769 >
7770 @end example
7771 @end deffn
7772
7773 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7774 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7775 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7776 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7777 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7778 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7779 (and enter debug mode).
7780 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7781
7782 @quotation Warning
7783 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7784 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7785 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7786 power mode by gating the core clock;
7787 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7788
7789 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7790 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7791 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7792 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7793 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7794 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7795
7796 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7797 work with a JTAG debugger.
7798 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7799 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7800 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7801 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7802 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7803 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7804 @end quotation
7805
7806 @end deffn
7807
7808 @deffn Command resume [address]
7809 Resume the target at its current code position,
7810 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7811 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7812 @end deffn
7813
7814 @deffn Command step [address]
7815 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7816 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7817 @end deffn
7818
7819 @anchor{resetcommand}
7820 @deffn Command reset
7821 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7822 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7823 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7824 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7825 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7826 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7827
7828 The optional parameter specifies what should
7829 happen after the reset.
7830 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7831 The other options will not work on all systems.
7832 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7833
7834 @itemize @minus
7835 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7836 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7837 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7838 @end itemize
7839 @end deffn
7840
7841 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7842 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7843 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7844 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7845 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7846 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7847 state.
7848 @end deffn
7849
7850 @section I/O Utilities
7851
7852 These commands are available when
7853 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7854 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7855 notably the ZY1000.
7856 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7857
7858 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7859
7860 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7861 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7862 the text file @file{filename}.
7863 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7864 The last string is followed by a newline.
7865 @end deffn
7866
7867 @deffn Command cat filename
7868 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7869 @end deffn
7870
7871 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7872 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7873 into @file{dest_filename}.
7874 @end deffn
7875
7876 @deffn Command ip
7877 @emph{No description provided.}
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn Command ls
7881 @emph{No description provided.}
7882 @end deffn
7883
7884 @deffn Command mac
7885 @emph{No description provided.}
7886 @end deffn
7887
7888 @deffn Command meminfo
7889 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7890 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7891 @end deffn
7892
7893 @deffn Command peek
7894 @emph{No description provided.}
7895 @end deffn
7896
7897 @deffn Command poke
7898 @emph{No description provided.}
7899 @end deffn
7900
7901 @deffn Command rm filename
7902 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7903 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7904 @end deffn
7905
7906 @deffn Command trunc filename
7907 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7908 @end deffn
7909
7910 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7911 @section Memory access commands
7912 @cindex memory access
7913
7914 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7915 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7916 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7917 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7918
7919 @enumerate
7920 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7921 to change the current target.
7922 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7923 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7924 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7925 @end enumerate
7926
7927 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7928 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7929 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7930 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7931 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7932 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7933 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7934 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7935 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7936 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7937 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7938 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7939 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7940 @end deffn
7941
7942 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7943 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7944 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7945 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7946 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7947 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7948 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7949 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7950 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7951 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7952 @end deffn
7953
7954 @anchor{imageaccess}
7955 @section Image loading commands
7956 @cindex image loading
7957 @cindex image dumping
7958
7959 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7960 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7961 binary file named @var{filename}.
7962 @end deffn
7963
7964 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7965 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7966 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7967 @end deffn
7968
7969 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7970 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7971 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7972 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7973 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7974 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7975 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7976 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7977 separately.
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7981 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7982 The file format may optionally be specified
7983 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7984 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7985 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7986 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7987 @example
7988 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7989 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7990 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7991 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7992 $address $length
7993 @}
7994 @end example
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7998 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7999 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8000 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8001 The file format may optionally be specified
8002 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8003 @end deffn
8004
8005 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8006 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8007 The file format may optionally be specified
8008 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8009 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8010 @end deffn
8011
8012 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8013 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8014 The file format may optionally be specified
8015 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8016 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8017 @end deffn
8018
8019
8020 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8021 @cindex breakpoint
8022 @cindex watchpoint
8023
8024 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8025 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8026 watchpoints.
8027 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8028
8029 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8030 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8031 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8032 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8033 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8034 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8035
8036 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8037 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040 @deffn Command {rbp} address
8041 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
8042 @end deffn
8043
8044 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8045 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8046 @end deffn
8047
8048 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8049 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8050 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8051 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8052 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8053 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8054 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8055 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8056 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8057 @end deffn
8058
8059 @section Misc Commands
8060
8061 @cindex profiling
8062 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8063 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8064 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8065 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8066 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8067 limit the address range.
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn Command {version}
8071 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8072 @end deffn
8073
8074 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8075 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8076 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8077 @end deffn
8078
8079 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8080 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8081 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8082 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8083
8084 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8085 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8086 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8087 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8088
8089 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8090 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8091 @cindex tracing
8092 @cindex ETM
8093 @cindex ETB
8094
8095 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8096 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8097 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8098
8099 @itemize
8100 @item
8101 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8102 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8103 supports such an interface.
8104 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8105 and trace port support.)
8106 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8107 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8108 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8109 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8110 in the board-specific configuration file.
8111 @item
8112 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8113 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8114 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8115 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8116 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8117 @end itemize
8118
8119 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8120
8121 @quotation Issues
8122 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8123 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8124
8125 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8126 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8127 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8128 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8129 dummy trace port driver}.
8130
8131 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8132 as well as tracing only during specific states
8133 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8134
8135 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8136 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8137 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8138 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8139 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8140
8141 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8142 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8143 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8144 this original style of JTAG access.
8145 @end quotation
8146
8147 @subsection ETM Configuration
8148 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8149
8150 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8151 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8152 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8153
8154 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8155 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8156 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8157 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8158 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8159 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8160 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8161 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8162 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8163
8164 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8165 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8166 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8167
8168 @quotation Warning
8169 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8170 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8171 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8172 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8173 @end quotation
8174
8175 @quotation Note
8176 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8177 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8178 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8179 what CPU activities are traced.
8180 @end quotation
8181 @end deffn
8182
8183 @deffn Command {etm info}
8184 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8185 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8186 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8187 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8188 @end deffn
8189
8190 @deffn Command {etm status}
8191 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8192 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8193 Did trace data overflow?
8194 Was it triggered?
8195 @end deffn
8196
8197 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8198 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8199 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8200 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8201 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8202
8203 @itemize
8204 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8205 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8206 The value is one of
8207 @option{none} (save nothing),
8208 @option{data} (save data),
8209 @option{address} (save addresses),
8210 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8211 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8212 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8213 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8214 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8215 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8216 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8217 trace stream without an image of the code.
8218 @end itemize
8219 @end deffn
8220
8221 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8222 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8223 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8224 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8225 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8226
8227 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8228 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8229 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8230 @end deffn
8231
8232 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8233
8234 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8235 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8236 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8237
8238 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8239 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8240 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8241 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8242 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8243 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8244 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8245
8246 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8247
8248 @itemize
8249 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8250 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8251 for instruction access within that function's body.
8252 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8253 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8254 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8255 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8256 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8257 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8258 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8259 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8260 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8261 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8262 @item @emph{... more}
8263 @end itemize
8264
8265 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8266 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8267
8268 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8269 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8270 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8271 @end deffn
8272
8273 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8274 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8275 @end deffn
8276
8277 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8278 Opens an image file.
8279 @end deffn
8280
8281 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8282 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8283 @end deffn
8284
8285 @deffn Command {etm start}
8286 Starts trace data collection.
8287 @end deffn
8288
8289 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8290 Stops trace data collection.
8291 @end deffn
8292
8293 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8294 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8295
8296 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8297
8298 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8299 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8300 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8301 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8302 any trace data collection.}
8303 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8304 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8305 @end deffn
8306 @end deffn
8307
8308 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8309 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8310 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8311 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8312 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8313 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8314 @end deffn
8315 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8316 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8317 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8318 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8319 trace trigger becomes active.
8320
8321 @itemize
8322 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8323 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8324 afterwards.
8325 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8326 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8327 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8328 what caused that event to happen.
8329 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8330 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8331 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8332 how the event caused trouble.
8333 @end itemize
8334 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8340 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8341 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8342 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8343 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8344
8345 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8346 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8347
8348 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8349 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8350 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8351 @end deffn
8352
8353 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8354 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8355 @end deffn
8356
8357 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8358 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8359 @end deffn
8360 @end deffn
8361
8362 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8363 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8364 @cindex CTI
8365
8366 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8367 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8368 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8369 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8370 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8371 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8372
8373 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8374 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8375 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8376 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8377 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8378 including additional configuration.
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8382 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8386 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8390 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8394 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8395 @end deffn
8396
8397 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8398 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8399 of the CTI.
8400 @end deffn
8401
8402 @deffn Command {cti names}
8403 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8404 useful in TCL scripting.
8405 @end deffn
8406
8407 @section Generic ARM
8408 @cindex ARM
8409
8410 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8411 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8412 commands that may be available.
8413
8414 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8415 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8416 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8417 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8418 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8419 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8423 @cindex disassemble
8424 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8425 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8426 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8427 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8428 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8429 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8430 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8431
8432 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8433 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8434 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8435 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8436 with a handful of exceptions.
8437 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8438 @end deffn
8439
8440 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8441 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8442 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8443 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8444 and using the MCR instruction.
8445 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8446 an ARM register.)
8447 @end deffn
8448
8449 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8450 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8451 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8452 and the MRC instruction.
8453 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8454 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8455 an ARM register.)
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8459 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8460 core mode if necessary.
8461 @end deffn
8462
8463 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8464 @cindex ARM semihosting
8465 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8466
8467 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8468 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8469 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8470 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8471 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8472 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8473 @end deffn
8474
8475 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8476 @cindex ARM semihosting
8477 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8478
8479 @example
8480 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8481 @end example
8482
8483 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8484 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8485 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8486 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8490 @cindex ARM semihosting
8491 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8492 status.
8493
8494 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8495 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8496 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8497 debugger.
8498 @end deffn
8499
8500 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8501 @cindex ARM semihosting
8502 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8503
8504 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8505 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8506 the value returned by the target.
8507
8508 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8509 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8510 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8511 encountering a break.
8512
8513 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8514 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8515 to the debugger.
8516 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8517 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8518 request or equivalent").
8519
8520 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8521 this option (default: disabled).
8522 @end deffn
8523
8524 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8525 @cindex ARMv4
8526 @cindex ARMv5
8527
8528 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8529 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8530 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8531 variant.
8532
8533 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8534 @cindex ARM7
8535 @cindex ARM9
8536
8537 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8538 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8539 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8540 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8541
8542 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8543 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8544 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8545 instead of breakpoints.
8546 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8547
8548 This should be
8549 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8550 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8551 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8552 @end deffn
8553
8554 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8555 @cindex DCC
8556 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8557 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8558 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8559
8560 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8561 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8562 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8563 @end deffn
8564
8565 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8566 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8567 that don't check completion of the operation.
8568 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8569
8570 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8571 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8572 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8573 @end deffn
8574
8575 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8576 @cindex ARM720T
8577
8578 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8579 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8580 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8581 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8582
8583 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8584 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8585 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8586
8587 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8588 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8589 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8590 @end deffn
8591
8592 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8593 @cindex ARM9
8594
8595 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8596 integer processors.
8597 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8598
8599 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8600 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8601 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8602 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8603
8604 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8605 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8606 @cindex vector_catch
8607 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8608 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8609 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8610 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8611 to those hardware vectors.
8612
8613 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8614 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8615 vector catch hardware to intercept
8616 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8617 @option{none} of them,
8618 or a list with one or more of the following:
8619 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8620 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8624 @cindex ARM920T
8625
8626 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8627 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8628 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8629 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8630 and ARM9 commands.
8631
8632 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8633 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8634 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8635 @end deffn
8636
8637 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8638 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8639 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8640 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8641 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8642 (Not all registers can be written.)
8643 @end deffn
8644
8645 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8646 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8647 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8648
8649 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8650 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8651 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8652 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8653 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8654 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8658 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8662 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8663 @end deffn
8664
8665 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8666 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8667
8668 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8669 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8670 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8671 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8672 and ARM9 commands.
8673
8674 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8675 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8676
8677 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8678 Print information about the caches found.
8679 @end deffn
8680
8681 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8682 @cindex ARM966E
8683
8684 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8685 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8686 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8687 and ARM9 commands.
8688
8689 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8690 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8691 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8692 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8693 ARM966E-S TRM.
8694 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8695 as required for BIST support.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @subsection XScale specific commands
8699 @cindex XScale
8700
8701 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8702
8703 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8704 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8705 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8706 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8707 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8708 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8709 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8710
8711 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8712 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8713 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8714 the mini-IC.
8715
8716 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8717 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8718 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8719 code layout in memory:
8720 @example
8721 _vectors:
8722 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8723 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8724 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8725 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8726 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8727 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8728 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8729 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8730 .org 0x100
8731 .long real_reset_vector
8732 .long real_ui_handler
8733 .long real_swi_handler
8734 .long real_pf_abort
8735 .long real_data_abort
8736 .long 0 /* unused */
8737 .long real_irq_handler
8738 .long real_fiq_handler
8739 @end example
8740
8741 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8742 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8743 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8744 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8745 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8746 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8747 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8748 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8749 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8750 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8751 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8752 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8753 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8754 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8755 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8756 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8757 software.
8758
8759 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8760 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8761 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8762 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8763
8764 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8765 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8766 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8767 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8768 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8769 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8770 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8771 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8772 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8773
8774 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8775 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8776
8777 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8778 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8779 @end deffn
8780
8781 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8782 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8783 @end deffn
8784
8785 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8786 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8787 @end deffn
8788
8789 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8790 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8791 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8792 @end deffn
8793
8794 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8795 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8796 @end deffn
8797
8798 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8799 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8800 @end deffn
8801
8802 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8803 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8804 @end deffn
8805
8806 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8807 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8808 @end deffn
8809
8810 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8811 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8812 @end deffn
8813
8814 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8815 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8816 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8817 and modifying how it is emptied.
8818 @end deffn
8819
8820 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8821 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8822 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8823 The image @var{type} may be one of
8824 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8825 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8826 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8827 @end deffn
8828
8829 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8830 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8831 @cindex vector_catch
8832 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8833 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8834
8835 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8836 @example
8837 0x01 Trap Reset
8838 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8839 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8840 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8841 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8842 0x20 reserved
8843 0x40 Trap IRQ
8844 0x80 Trap FIQ
8845 @end example
8846 @end deffn
8847
8848 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8849 @cindex vector_table
8850
8851 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8852 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8853 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8854 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8855 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8856
8857 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8858
8859 @end deffn
8860
8861 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8862 @cindex ARMv6
8863
8864 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8865 @cindex ARM11
8866
8867 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8868 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8869 which is enabled by default.
8870 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8871 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8872 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8873 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8874 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8875 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8876 @end deffn
8877
8878 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8879 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8880 which is enabled by default.
8881 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8882 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8883 @end deffn
8884
8885 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8886 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8887 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8888 they are disabled by default.
8889 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8893 @cindex vector_catch
8894 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8895 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8896 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8897
8898 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8899 for certain hardware events.
8900 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8901 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8902 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8903 @end deffn
8904
8905 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8906 @cindex ARMv7
8907 @cindex ARMv8
8908
8909 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8910 @cindex Cortex-A
8911
8912 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8913 display information about target caches
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8917 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8918 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8919 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8920 Defaults to 'off'.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8924 Initialize core debug
8925 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8926 @end deffn
8927
8928 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8929 Disable SMP mode
8930 @end deffn
8931
8932 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8933 Enable SMP mode
8934 @end deffn
8935
8936 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8937 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8938 @end deffn
8939
8940 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8941 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8942 @end deffn
8943
8944 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8945 configure l2x cache
8946 @end deffn
8947
8948 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
8949 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
8950 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
8951 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
8952 possible (4096) entries are printed.
8953 @end deffn
8954
8955 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8956 @cindex Cortex-R
8957
8958 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8959 Initialize core debug
8960 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8961 @end deffn
8962
8963 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8964 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8965 @end deffn
8966
8967
8968 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8969 @cindex tracing
8970 @cindex SWO
8971 @cindex SWV
8972 @cindex TPIU
8973 @cindex ITM
8974 @cindex ETM
8975
8976 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8977 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8978 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8979
8980 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8981 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8982 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8983 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8984
8985 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8986 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8987 debugger adapter features.
8988
8989 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8990 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8991
8992 Command options:
8993 @itemize @minus
8994 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8995 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8996 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8997 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8998 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8999 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9000 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9001 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9002 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9003 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9004 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9005 coding;
9006 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9007 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9008 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9009 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9010 data is to be output via SWO;
9011 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9012 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9013 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9014 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9015 rate automatically.
9016 @end itemize
9017
9018 Example usage:
9019 @enumerate
9020 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9021 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9022 enough to:
9023 @example
9024 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9025 ...
9026 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9027 ...
9028 @end example
9029 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9030 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9031 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9032 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9033 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9034 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9035 @example
9036 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9037 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9038 @end example
9039 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9040 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9041 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9042 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9043 @example
9044 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9045 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9046 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9047 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9048 @end example
9049 @end enumerate
9050 @end deffn
9051
9052 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9053 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9054 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9055 @end deffn
9056
9057 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9058 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9059 @end deffn
9060
9061 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9062 @cindex Cortex-M
9063
9064 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9065 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9066
9067 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9068 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9069 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9070 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9071 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9072 the step command leaves with the core running.
9073
9074 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9075 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9076 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9077 does.
9078
9079 Default is @option{auto}.
9080 @end deffn
9081
9082 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9083 @cindex vector_catch
9084 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9085 for certain hardware events.
9086
9087 Parameters request interception of
9088 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9089 @option{none} of them,
9090 or one or more of the following:
9091 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9092 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9093 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9094 @option{irq_err},
9095 @option{state_err},
9096 @option{chk_err}, or
9097 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9098 @option{reset}.
9099 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9100 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9101 are mapped to HardFault.
9102 UsageFault checks for
9103 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9104 must also be explicitly enabled.
9105
9106 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9107 @end deffn
9108
9109 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9110 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9111 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9112
9113 @itemize @minus
9114 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9115 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9116 @end itemize
9117
9118 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9119 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9120 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9121 to manually reset the peripherals.
9122 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9123
9124 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9125 instead.
9126 @end deffn
9127
9128 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9129 @cindex ARMv8-A
9130 @cindex aarch64
9131
9132 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9133 Display information about target caches
9134 @end deffn
9135
9136 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9137 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9138 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9139 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9140 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9141 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
9145 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9146 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9147 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9148 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9149 @end deffn
9150
9151 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9152 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9153 @option{on}.
9154 @end deffn
9155
9156 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9157
9158 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9159 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9160
9161 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9162
9163 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9164 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9165 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9166 @end deffn
9167
9168 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9169 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9170 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9171 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9172 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9173 @end deffn
9174
9175 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9176
9177 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9178 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9179 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9180 @end deffn
9181
9182 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9183
9184 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9185 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9186 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9187 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9188 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9189 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9190 can be collected.
9191
9192 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9193 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9194 tooling.
9195
9196 @quotation Issues
9197 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9198 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9199 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9200 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9201
9202 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9203 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9204 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9205 software operation on the CPU.
9206 @end quotation
9207
9208 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9209 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9210 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9211 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9212 @end deffn
9213
9214 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9215 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9216 @end deffn
9217
9218 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9219 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9220 control is disabled.
9221 @end deffn
9222
9223 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9224 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9225 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9226 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9227
9228 Supported trace formats:
9229 @itemize
9230 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9231 timing to be determined.
9232 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9233 addresses.
9234 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9235 @end itemize
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9239 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9240 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9241 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9242
9243 Supported conditions:
9244 @itemize
9245 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9246 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9247 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9248 instruction matches start data and mask.
9249 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9250 instruction matches start data and mask.
9251 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9252 data and mask.
9253 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9254 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9255 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9256 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9257 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9258 @end itemize
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9262 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9263 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9264 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9265
9266 Supported conditions:
9267 @itemize
9268 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9269 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9270 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9271 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9272 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9273 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9274 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9275 data and mask.
9276 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9277 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9278 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9279 @end itemize
9280 @end deffn
9281
9282 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9283 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9284
9285 Supported triggers:
9286 @itemize
9287 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9288 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9289 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9290 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9291 collection.
9292 @end itemize
9293 @end deffn
9294
9295 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9296
9297 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9298 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9299 configuration changes. If an trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9300 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9301 @end deffn
9302
9303 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9304 Display trace configuration.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9308 Display trace collection status.
9309 @end deffn
9310
9311 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9312 Start manual trace collection.
9313 @end deffn
9314
9315 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9316 Stop manual trace collection.
9317 @end deffn
9318
9319 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9320 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9321 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9322 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9323 @option{size} options using DMA.
9324 @end deffn
9325
9326 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9327 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9328 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9329 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9330 @option{size} options using DMA.
9331 @end deffn
9332
9333 @section Intel Architecture
9334
9335 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9336 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9337 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9338 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9339 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9340 @itemize
9341 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9342 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9343 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9344 @end itemize
9345
9346 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9347 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9348 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9349
9350 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9351 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9352 @end deffn
9353
9354 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9355 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9356 @end deffn
9357
9358 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9359 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9360 @end deffn
9361
9362 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9363 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9364 @end deffn
9365
9366 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9367 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9368 @end deffn
9369
9370 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9371 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9372 @end deffn
9373
9374 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9375
9376 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9377 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9378
9379 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9380 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9381 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9382 @end deffn
9383 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9384 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9385
9386 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9387
9388 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9389 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9390 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @subsection Registers commands
9394 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9395 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9396 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9397
9398 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9399
9400 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9401 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9402 and "timer" groups.
9403
9404 @emph{example:}
9405 @example
9406 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9407 @end example
9408
9409
9410 @end deffn
9411 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9412 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9413
9414 @emph{group} can be "system",
9415 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9416 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @section RISC-V Architecture
9420
9421 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9422 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9423 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9424 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9425 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9426 implement version 0.11.
9427
9428 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9429
9430 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9431 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9432 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9433
9434 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9435
9436 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9437 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9438 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9439
9440 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9441 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9442 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9443 CSRs.
9444 @end deffn
9445
9446 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9447 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9448 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9452 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9453 deasserted.
9454 @end deffn
9455
9456 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9457 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9458 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9459 @end deffn
9460
9461 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9462 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9463 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9464 @end deffn
9465
9466 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9467
9468 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9469 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9470 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9471 @example
9472 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9473 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9474 @end example
9475
9476 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9477 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9478 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9479 @end deffn
9480
9481 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9482 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9483 @end deffn
9484
9485 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9486
9487 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9488 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9489
9490 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9491 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9492 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9493 dmi_read}.
9494 @end deffn
9495
9496 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9497 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9498 @end deffn
9499
9500 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9501 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9502 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9503 @cindex tracing
9504 @cindex libdcc
9505 @cindex DCC
9506 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9507 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9508 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9509 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9510
9511 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9512 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9513 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9514 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9515 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9516 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9517
9518 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9519 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9520 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9521 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9522 The target being debugged may
9523 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9524 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9525 each supported by a command:
9526
9527 @itemize
9528 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9529 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9530 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9531 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9532
9533 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9534 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9535 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9536
9537 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9538 and then displayed at any time.
9539 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9540
9541 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9542 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9543 @end itemize
9544
9545 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9546 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9547 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9548 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9549 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9550 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9551 does the same thing.
9552
9553 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9554 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9555 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9556 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9557 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9558
9559 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9560 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9561 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9562 @end deffn
9563
9564 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9565 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9566 in the order they triggered.
9567 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9568 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9569 history records.
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9573 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9574 they have been triggered.
9575 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9576 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9577 and associates it with that identifier.
9578
9579 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9580 are not related except by this command.
9581 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9582 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9583 @end deffn
9584
9585
9586 @node JTAG Commands
9587 @chapter JTAG Commands
9588 @cindex JTAG Commands
9589 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9590 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9591 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9592 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9593 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9594
9595 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9596 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9597
9598 @itemize @bullet
9599 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9600 devices such as a CPUs.
9601 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9602 standard state machine (in parallel)
9603 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9604 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9605 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9606 while the reading previous ones.
9607 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9608 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9609 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9610 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9611 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9612 registers.
9613 @end itemize
9614
9615 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9616
9617 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9618 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9619 the order of TAP state transitions.
9620 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9621 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9622 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9623 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9624 these commands are not available.
9625
9626 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9627 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9628 that specify the entire register.
9629 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9630 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9631 The return value holds the original value of each
9632 of those fields.
9633
9634 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9635 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9636 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9637 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9638 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9639
9640 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9641 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9642
9643 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9644 in that state.
9645 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9646 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9647 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9648
9649 @quotation Warning
9650 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9651 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9652 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9653 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9654 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9655 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9656 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9657 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9658 @end quotation
9659 @end deffn
9660
9661 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9662 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9663 This may be used for performance tuning.
9664
9665 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9666 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9667 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9668 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9669 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9670 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9671 @end deffn
9672
9673 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9674 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9675 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9676 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9677 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9678 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9679
9680 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9681 in that state.
9682 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9683 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9684 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9685
9686 @quotation Note
9687 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9688 register values, unlike data register values.
9689 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9690 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9691 @end quotation
9692 @end deffn
9693
9694 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9695 Set values of reset signals.
9696 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9697 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9698 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9699 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9700 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9701 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9702 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9703
9704 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9705 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9706 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9707 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9708 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9709 instead of the TRST signal.
9710 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9711 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9712 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9713 with handlers for that event.
9714 @end deffn
9715
9716 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9717 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9718 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9719 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9720 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9721 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9722 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9723 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9724 The final state must also be stable.
9725 @end deffn
9726
9727 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9728 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9729 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9730 Instructions often need some time
9731 to execute before they take effect.
9732 @end deffn
9733
9734 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9735 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9736
9737 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9738 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9739 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9740 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9741 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9742 @end deffn
9743
9744 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9745 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9746 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9747 must also be enabled.
9748 Default is enabled.
9749 @end deffn
9750
9751 @section TAP state names
9752 @cindex TAP state names
9753
9754 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9755 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9756 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9757 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9758
9759 @itemize @bullet
9760 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9761 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9762 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9763 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9764 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9765 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9766 through the data register
9767 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9768 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9769 for update or more shifting
9770 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9771 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9772 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9773 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9774 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9775 through the instruction register
9776 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9777 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9778 for update or more shifting
9779 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9780 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9781 @end itemize
9782
9783 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9784 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9785 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9786 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9787
9788 @itemize @bullet
9789 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9790 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9791 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9792 may not be as expected.
9793 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9794 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9795 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9796 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9797 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9798 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9802 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9803
9804 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9805 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9806 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9807 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9808
9809 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9810 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9811 @cindex SVF
9812
9813 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9814 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9815 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9816 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9817
9818 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9819 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9820 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9821 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9822
9823 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9824 affect their semantics.
9825
9826 Command options:
9827 @itemize @minus
9828 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9829 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9830 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9831 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9832 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9833 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9834 on the real interface;
9835 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9836 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9837 errors.
9838 @end itemize
9839 @end deffn
9840
9841 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9842 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9843 @cindex XSVF
9844
9845 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9846 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9847 Xilinx devices.
9848 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9849 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9850
9851 @quotation Important
9852 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9853 @end quotation
9854
9855 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9856 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9857 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9858 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9859 that TAP.
9860 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9861 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9862 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9863 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9864 @end deffn
9865
9866 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9867 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9868 after building the software.
9869 You may find them useful:
9870
9871 @itemize
9872 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9873 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9874 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9875 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9876 @end itemize
9877
9878 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9879 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9880 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9881 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9882 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9883 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9884 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9885
9886
9887 @node Utility Commands
9888 @chapter Utility Commands
9889 @cindex Utility Commands
9890
9891 @section RAM testing
9892 @cindex RAM testing
9893
9894 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9895 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9896 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9897 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9898 hardware problems.
9899
9900 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9901 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9902 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9903 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9904
9905 Load the memory testing functions with
9906
9907 @example
9908 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9909 @end example
9910
9911 to get access to the following facilities:
9912
9913 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9914 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9915 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9916 @end deffn
9917
9918 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9919 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9920 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9921 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9922 @end deffn
9923
9924 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9925 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9926 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9927 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9928 @end deffn
9929
9930 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9931 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9932 @end deffn
9933
9934 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9935 @cindex Firmware recovery
9936
9937 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9938 devices recovery with JTAG.
9939
9940 For quickstart instructions run:
9941 @example
9942 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9943 @end example
9944
9945 @node TFTP
9946 @chapter TFTP
9947 @cindex TFTP
9948 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9949 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9950
9951 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9952 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9953 server (tftpd). For example,
9954
9955 @example
9956 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9957 @end example
9958
9959 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9960 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9961
9962 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9963 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9964 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9965 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9966
9967 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9968 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9969 @cindex GDB
9970 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9971 to debug remote targets.
9972 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9973
9974 @itemize
9975 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9976 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9977 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9978 as shown in this chapter.
9979 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9980 that also will probably need to be configured.
9981 @end itemize
9982
9983 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9984 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9985 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9986 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9987 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9988 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9989
9990 @section Connecting to GDB
9991 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9992 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9993 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9994 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9995 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9996
9997 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9998
9999 @enumerate
10000 @item
10001 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10002 @example
10003 target remote localhost:3333
10004 @end example
10005 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10006
10007 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10008 @example
10009 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10010 @end example
10011 @item
10012 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10013 @example
10014 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10015 @end example
10016 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10017 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10018 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10019 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10020 @end enumerate
10021
10022 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10023 GDB command line.
10024
10025 @section Sample GDB session startup
10026
10027 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10028 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10029 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10030 small ARM program.
10031 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10032 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10033
10034 @example
10035 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10036 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10037 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10038 ...
10039 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10040 ...
10041 (gdb) load
10042 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10043 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10044 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10045 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10046 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10047 (gdb) continue
10048 Continuing.
10049 ...
10050 @end example
10051
10052 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10053 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10054 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10055 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10056
10057 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10058
10059 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10060 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10061 packet size and the device's memory map.
10062 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10063 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10064 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10065
10066 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10067 You may need to set those up by hand.
10068 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10069 something like:
10070
10071 @example
10072 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10073 @end example
10074
10075 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10076
10077 @example
10078 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10079 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10080 @end example
10081
10082 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10083 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10084 do not have such restrictions.
10085
10086 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10087 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10088 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10089 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10090
10091 @section Programming using GDB
10092 @cindex Programming using GDB
10093 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10094
10095 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10096 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10097 @example
10098 gdb_memory_map disable
10099 @end example
10100 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10101 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10102 working area.
10103
10104 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10105 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10106 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10107 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10108
10109 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10110 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10111
10112 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10113 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10114 @example
10115 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10116 @end example
10117
10118 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10119 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10120
10121 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10122 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10123 will be used.
10124
10125 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10126 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10127 @example
10128 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10129 @end example
10130 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10131
10132 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10133 can be used.
10134
10135 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10136 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10137 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10138
10139 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10140 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10141 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10142
10143 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10144 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10145 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10146 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10147 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10148 without any intrusion of the target process.
10149
10150 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10151 Place following command after target configuration:
10152 @example
10153 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10154 @end example
10155
10156 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10157 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10158 @example
10159 gdb_memory_map disable
10160 @end example
10161
10162 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10163 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10164 @example
10165 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10166 @end example
10167
10168 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10169 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10170
10171 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10172 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10173 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10174 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10175
10176 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10177 previously shown varibles.
10178
10179 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10180 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10181 @cindex SMP
10182 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10183 @itemize @bullet
10184 @item j - smp status request
10185 @item J - smp set request
10186 @end itemize
10187
10188 OpenOCD implements :
10189 @itemize @bullet
10190 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10191 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10192 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10193 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10194 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10195 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10196 @end itemize
10197
10198 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10199 @itemize @bullet
10200 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10201 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10202 @example
10203 set $_core 1
10204 #Jc01 packet is sent
10205 print $_core
10206 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10207 @end example
10208
10209 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10210 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10211
10212 @example
10213 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10214 define toggle0
10215 maint packet Jc0
10216 continue
10217 main packet Jc-1
10218 end
10219 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10220 define toggle1
10221 maint packet Jc1
10222 continue
10223 main packet Jc-1
10224 end
10225 @end example
10226 @end itemize
10227
10228 @section RTOS Support
10229 @cindex RTOS Support
10230 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10231
10232 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10233 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10234
10235 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10236 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10237 GDB commands.
10238
10239 @* An example setup is below:
10240
10241 @example
10242 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10243 @end example
10244
10245 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10246
10247 Currently supported rtos's include:
10248 @itemize @bullet
10249 @item @option{eCos}
10250 @item @option{ThreadX}
10251 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10252 @item @option{linux}
10253 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10254 @item @option{embKernel}
10255 @item @option{mqx}
10256 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10257 @item @option{nuttx}
10258 @end itemize
10259
10260 @quotation Note
10261 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10262 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10263 @end quotation
10264
10265 @table @code
10266 @item eCos symbols
10267 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10268 @item ThreadX symbols
10269 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10270 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10271 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10272 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10273 @tex
10274 \begingroup
10275 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10276 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10277 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10278 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10279 \par
10280 \endgroup
10281 @end tex
10282 @item linux symbols
10283 init_task.
10284 @item ChibiOS symbols
10285 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10286 @item embKernel symbols
10287 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10288 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10289 @item mqx symbols
10290 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10291 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10292 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10293 @item nuttx symbols
10294 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10295 @end table
10296
10297 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10298 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10299
10300 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10301 along with the project:
10302
10303 @table @code
10304 @item FreeRTOS
10305 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10306 @item uC/OS-III
10307 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10308 @end table
10309
10310 @node Tcl Scripting API
10311 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10312 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10313 @cindex Tcl scripts
10314 @section API rules
10315
10316 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10317 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10318 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10319
10320 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10321 pair list and lists.
10322
10323 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10324 list.
10325
10326 @example
10327 > set foo(me) Duane
10328 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10329 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10330 > set foo(duck) Donald
10331 @end example
10332
10333 If one does this:
10334
10335 @example
10336 > set foo
10337 @end example
10338
10339 The result is:
10340
10341 @example
10342 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10343 @end example
10344
10345 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10346
10347 @verbatim
10348 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10349 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10350 }
10351 @end verbatim
10352
10353 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10354 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10355
10356 @section Internal low-level Commands
10357
10358 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10359 invoke directly.
10360
10361 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10362 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10363 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10364
10365 @itemize @bullet
10366 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10367
10368 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10369 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10370
10371 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10372 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10373
10374 Return information about the flash banks
10375
10376 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10377
10378 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10379 its execution. Example:
10380
10381 @example
10382 > capture "reset init"
10383 @end example
10384
10385 @end itemize
10386
10387 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10388 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10389 called "flash_banks".
10390
10391 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10392
10393 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10394 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10395 holds one of the following values:
10396
10397 @itemize @bullet
10398 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10399 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10400 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10401 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10402 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10403 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10404 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10405 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10406 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10407 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10408 @end itemize
10409
10410 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10411
10412 @quotation Note
10413 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10414 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10415 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10416 is jim, not real tcl).
10417 @end quotation
10418
10419 @section Tcl RPC server
10420 @cindex RPC
10421
10422 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10423 commands and receive the results.
10424
10425 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10426 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10427 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10428 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10429 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10430
10431 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10432 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10433 @command{capture} command.
10434
10435 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10436
10437 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10438 @cindex RPC Notifications
10439
10440 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10441 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10442
10443 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10444 in the following format.
10445
10446 @verbatim
10447 type target_event event [event-name]
10448 type target_state state [state-name]
10449 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10450 @end verbatim
10451
10452 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10453 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10454 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10455 Defaults to off.
10456
10457 @end deffn
10458
10459 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10460 @cindex RPC trace output
10461
10462 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10463 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10464
10465 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10466
10467 @verbatim
10468 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10469 @end verbatim
10470
10471 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10472 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10473 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10474 Defaults to off.
10475
10476 See an example application here:
10477 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10478
10479 @end deffn
10480
10481 @node FAQ
10482 @chapter FAQ
10483 @cindex faq
10484 @enumerate
10485 @anchor{faqrtck}
10486 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10487 @cindex RTCK
10488 @cindex adaptive clocking
10489 @*
10490
10491 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10492 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10493 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10494 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10495
10496 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10497 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10498 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10499 @enumerate
10500 @item
10501 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10502 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10503 @item
10504 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10505 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10506 @end enumerate
10507
10508 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10509 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10510 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10511 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10512 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10513 power).
10514
10515 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10516 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10517 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10518 ARM926 scenario).
10519 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10520 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10521 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10522
10523 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10524 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10525 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10526 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10527
10528 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10529
10530 In order to make use of this,
10531 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10532 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10533
10534 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10535 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10536 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10537 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10538 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10539
10540 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10541 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10542 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10543 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10544
10545 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10546 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10547 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10548 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10549 with a CPLD.
10550 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10551 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10552 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10553 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10554 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10555 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10556
10557 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10558
10559 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10560
10561 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10562 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10563 depending on the chips on your board.
10564 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10565 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10566 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10567
10568 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10569 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10570 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10571
10572 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10573 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10574 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10575 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10576
10577 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10578 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10579 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10580 this way.
10581
10582 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10583 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10584 clock rate.
10585 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10586 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10587 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10588
10589 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10590
10591 @example
10592 # Example: 1.234MHz
10593 adapter_khz 1234
10594 @end example
10595
10596
10597 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10598
10599 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10600 around Windows filenames.
10601
10602 @example
10603 > echo \a
10604
10605 > echo @{\a@}
10606 \a
10607 > echo "\a"
10608
10609 >
10610 @end example
10611
10612
10613 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10614
10615 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10616 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10617 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10618
10619 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10620 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10621 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10622
10623 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10624 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10625 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10626
10627 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10628
10629 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10630 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10631 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10632 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10633
10634 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10635 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10636 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10637
10638 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10639 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10640
10641 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10642 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10643 memory read caused data abort".
10644
10645 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10646 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10647 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10648 be done, feel free to add this here.
10649
10650 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10651 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10652 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10653 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10654 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10655 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10656 gracefully stops.
10657
10658 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10659 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10660 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10661
10662 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10663 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10664 bytes. Painful...
10665
10666
10667 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10668 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10669
10670 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10671 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10672 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10673 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10674 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10675 reset, everything else should work fine.
10676
10677 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10678 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10679 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10680 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10681
10682 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10683 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10684 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10685 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10686
10687 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10688
10689 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10690 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10691 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10692
10693 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10694 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10695
10696 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10697 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10698 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10699 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10700 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10701 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10702 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10703 clock frequency?
10704
10705 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10706 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10707 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10708 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10709 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10710
10711 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10712
10713 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10714 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10715 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10716 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10717 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10718 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10719 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10720
10721 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10722
10723 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10724 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10725 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10726 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10727
10728 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10729 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10730 particular order?
10731
10732 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10733 the same order used by the hardware.
10734
10735 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10736 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10737 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10738 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10739 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10740 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10741
10742 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10743 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10744 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10745 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10746
10747 @itemize @bullet
10748 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10749 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10750 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10751 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10752 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10753 @end itemize
10754
10755 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10756
10757 @itemize @bullet
10758 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10759 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10760 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10761 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10762 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10763 @end itemize
10764
10765
10766 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10767 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10768 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10769
10770 TODO.
10771
10772 @end enumerate
10773
10774 @node Tcl Crash Course
10775 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10776 @cindex Tcl
10777
10778 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10779 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10780 how the Tcl scripts work.
10781
10782 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10783 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10784 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10785 OpenOCD.
10786
10787 @section Tcl Rule #1
10788 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10789 @enumerate
10790 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10791 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10792 @end enumerate
10793
10794 The Tcl equal is this:
10795
10796 @enumerate
10797 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10798 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10799 @end enumerate
10800
10801 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10802 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10803
10804 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10805 There is a second pair of rules.
10806 @enumerate
10807 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10808 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10809 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10810 in Tcl.
10811 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10812 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10813 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10814 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10815 @end enumerate
10816
10817 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10818 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10819 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10820 Everything is a string}
10821
10822 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10823 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10824 difference is subtle.
10825 @enumerate
10826 @item Parse Time
10827 @item Evaluation Time
10828 @end enumerate
10829
10830 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10831 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10832 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10833
10834 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10835 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10836 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10837 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10838
10839 @itemize @bullet
10840 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10841 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10842 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10843 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10844 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10845 @example
10846 # bash example
10847 X=`date`
10848 echo "The Date is: $X"
10849 # Tcl example
10850 set X [date]
10851 puts "The Date is: $X"
10852 @end example
10853 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10854 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10855 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10856 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10857 is a string}
10858 @example
10859 set x "Dinner"
10860 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10861 @end example
10862 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10863 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10864 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10865 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10866 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10867 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10868 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10869 @end itemize
10870
10871 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10872
10873 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10874
10875 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10876
10877 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10878 the normal way.
10879
10880 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10881 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10882 line is immediately executed.
10883
10884 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10885 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10886
10887 @subsection Command Execution
10888
10889 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10890 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10891 control flow operators.
10892
10893 Commands are executed like this:
10894
10895 @enumerate
10896 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10897 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10898 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10899 @end enumerate
10900
10901 It sort of works like this:
10902 @example
10903 for(;;)@{
10904 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10905
10906 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10907
10908 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10909 @}
10910 @end example
10911
10912 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10913 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10914 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10915 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10916 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10917 ``LookupCommand()''
10918
10919 @subsection The FOR command
10920
10921 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10922 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10923 command just like any other command.
10924
10925 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10926 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10927 are:
10928
10929 @enumerate 0
10930 @item The ascii text 'for'
10931 @item The start text
10932 @item The test expression
10933 @item The next text
10934 @item The body text
10935 @end enumerate
10936
10937 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10938 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10939 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10940 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10941
10942 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10943 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10944
10945 @example
10946 int
10947 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10948 int *argc,
10949 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10950 @end example
10951
10952 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10953 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10954 still operates in the same basic way.
10955
10956 @subsection FOR command implementation
10957
10958 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10959 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10960
10961 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10962
10963 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10964
10965 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10966 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10967 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10968
10969 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10970 expression and returns a value.
10971
10972 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10973 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10974 @example
10975 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10976
10977 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10978
10979 int
10980 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10981 int argc,
10982 char **argv )
10983 @{
10984 if( argc != 5 )@{
10985 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10986 return ERROR;
10987 @}
10988
10989 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10990
10991 // Execute the start statement.
10992 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10993
10994 // Top of loop test
10995 for(;;)@{
10996 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10997 if( i == 0 )
10998 break;
10999
11000 // Execute the body
11001 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11002
11003 // Execute the LOOP part
11004 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11005 @}
11006
11007 // Return no error
11008 SetResult( interp, "" );
11009 return SUCCESS;
11010 @}
11011 @end example
11012
11013 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11014 in the same basic way.
11015
11016 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11017
11018 @subsection source and find commands
11019 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11020 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11021 @*Remember the parsing rules
11022 @enumerate
11023 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11024 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11025 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11026 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11027 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11028 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11029 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11030 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11031 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11032 @end enumerate
11033 @subsection format command
11034 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11035 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11036 @b{sprintf()}.
11037 @b{Example}
11038 @example
11039 set x 6
11040 set y 7
11041 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11042 @end example
11043 @enumerate
11044 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11045 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11046 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11047 @* Refer to Rule #1
11048 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11049 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11050 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11051 @end enumerate
11052 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11053 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11054 @example
11055 #1 Good
11056 proc someproc @{@} @{
11057 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11058 @}
11059 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11060 #2 Good - no variables
11061 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11062 #3 Good Curly Braces
11063 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11064 puts "Time: [date]"
11065 @}
11066 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11067 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11068 @end example
11069 @enumerate
11070 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11071 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11072 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11073 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11074 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11075 command.
11076 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11077 @*There are 4 examples:
11078 @enumerate
11079 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11080 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11081 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11082 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11083 @end enumerate
11084
11085 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11086 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11087 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11088
11089 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11090 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11091 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11092 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11093 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11094 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11095 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11096 @end enumerate
11097 @subsection Global Variables
11098 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11099 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11100 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11101 @example
11102 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11103 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11104 global x #Global variable X
11105 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11106 @}
11107 @end example
11108 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11109 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11110 @example
11111 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11112 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11113 # Create var name
11114 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11115 # Make it a global
11116 global $vn
11117 # Set it.
11118 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11119 @}
11120 @end example
11121 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11122 @example
11123 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11124 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11125 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11126 @}
11127 @end example
11128
11129 @include fdl.texi
11130
11131 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11132 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11133 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11134 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11135 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11136 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11137
11138 @printindex cp
11139
11140 @node Command and Driver Index
11141 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11142 @printindex fn
11143
11144 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)